blob: e6373584dc44a4b6894cebdbb57e707e88438a29 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaud0089302020-04-17 14:19:38 +02007 2020/04/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +0200907.3.7. Fetching health-check samples
917.3.8. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100204For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
205the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
207is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
208servers.
209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210
2111.2. HTTP request
212-----------------
213
214First, let's consider this HTTP request :
215
216 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
219 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
220 3 User-agent: my small browser
221 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
222 5 Accept: image/png
223
224
2251.2.1. The Request line
226-----------------------
227
228Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
229
230 - a METHOD : GET
231 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
232 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
233
234All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
235which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
236followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
237is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
238desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
239the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
240
241The URI itself can have several forms :
242
243 - A "relative URI" :
244
245 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
246
247 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
248 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
249
250 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
251
252 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
253
254 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
255 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
256 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
257 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
258 must accept this form too.
259
260 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
261 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
262 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200264 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
265 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
266 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
267 other protocols too.
268
269In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
270mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
271on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
272It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
273specific to the language, framework or application in use.
274
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100276assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
278received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
279processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
280as well as in server logs.
281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
2831.2.2. The request headers
284--------------------------
285
286The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
287beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
288an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
289Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
290values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
291encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
292the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
293define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100295Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100297"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
298as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
339over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
385 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
388 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
389 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
390
391The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3924.2).
393
394
3951.3.2. The response headers
396---------------------------
397
398Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
399the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
400details.
401
402
4032. Configuring HAProxy
404----------------------
405
4062.1. Configuration file format
407------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200408
409HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
410
411 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
412 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
413 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
414 "frontend" and "backend".
415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
417referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200418delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200420
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004212.2. Quoting and escaping
422-------------------------
423
424HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
425many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
426with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
427single quotes.
428
429If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
430them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
431escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
432
433Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
434
435 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
436 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
437 \\ to use a backslash
438 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
439 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
440
441Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
442the interpretation of:
443
444 space as a parameter separator
445 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
446 # hash as a comment start
447
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200448Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
449-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
450backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
451
452Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200453quoting.
454
455Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
456nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
457
458Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
459equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
460
461 Example:
462 # those are equivalents:
463 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
465 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
467 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
468
469 # those are equivalents:
470 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
473 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
474
475
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004762.3. Environment variables
477--------------------------
478
479HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
480interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
481configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
482optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
483shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
484underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
485
486 Example:
487
488 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
489
490 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
491
492 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
495file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200496
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200497* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
498 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
499
500* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
501 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
502 directory.
503
504* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 processes, separated by semicolons.
508
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500509* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200510 CLI, separated by semicolons.
511
512See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200513
5142.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515----------------
516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100517Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100518values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
519otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
520numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
521for every keyword. Supported units are :
522
523 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
524 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
525 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
526 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
527 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
528 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
529
530
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005312.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200532-------------
533
534 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
535 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
536 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
537 global
538 daemon
539 maxconn 256
540
541 defaults
542 mode http
543 timeout connect 5000ms
544 timeout client 50000ms
545 timeout server 50000ms
546
547 frontend http-in
548 bind *:80
549 default_backend servers
550
551 backend servers
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
556 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
557 global
558 daemon
559 maxconn 256
560
561 defaults
562 mode http
563 timeout connect 5000ms
564 timeout client 50000ms
565 timeout server 50000ms
566
567 listen http-in
568 bind *:80
569 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
570
571
572Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
573
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100574 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200575
576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005773. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578--------------------
579
580Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
581are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
582of them have command-line equivalents.
583
584The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
585
586 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200589 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - description
593 - deviceatlas-json-file
594 - deviceatlas-log-level
595 - deviceatlas-separator
596 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900597 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - gid
599 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100600 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200601 - h1-case-adjust
602 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100603 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100604 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100605 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100608 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100610 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200611 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200613 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100616 - presetenv
617 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618 - uid
619 - ulimit-n
620 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200621 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100622 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200623 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-options
628 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200630 - ssl-default-server-options
631 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100632 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200633 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100634 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100635 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100636 - 51degrees-data-file
637 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200638 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200639 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200640 - wurfl-data-file
641 - wurfl-information-list
642 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200643 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100644 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100647 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200648 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200650 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100651 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100652 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100653 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200654 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200655 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200656 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200657 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200658 - noepoll
659 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000660 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100662 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300663 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000664 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100665 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200666 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200667 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200668 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000669 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000670 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200671 - tune.buffers.limit
672 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200673 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200674 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100675 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200676 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200677 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200678 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100679 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200680 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200681 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100682 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100683 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100684 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100685 - tune.lua.session-timeout
686 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200687 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100688 - tune.maxaccept
689 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200690 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200691 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200692 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.rcvbuf.client
694 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100695 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200696 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100697 - tune.sndbuf.client
698 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100699 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100700 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200701 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100702 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200703 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200704 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100705 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200706 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100707 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200708 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
709 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
710 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100711 - tune.zlib.memlevel
712 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100713
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200714 * Debugging
715 - debug
716 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200717 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200718
719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007203.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721------------------------------------
722
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200723ca-base <dir>
724 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100725 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
726 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
727 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200728
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200729chroot <jail dir>
730 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
731 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
732 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
733 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
734 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100735 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100736
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100737cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
738 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
739 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
740 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
741 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
742 set. These sets have the format
743
744 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
745
746 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100747 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
749 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100750 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
751 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100752 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100753 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100754 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100755 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
757 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
758 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
759 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100760
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100761 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
762 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
763 on the machine's word size.
764
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100765 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100766 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
767 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
768 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
769 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
770 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
771 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772
773 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100774 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
775
776 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
777 # first 4 CPUs
778
779 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
780 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
781 # word size.
782
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100783 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100784 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
786 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
787 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
788
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100789 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
790 # and so on.
791 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
792 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
794
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100795 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100796 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
797 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
798 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
799
800 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
801 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
802 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
803
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100804 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
805 # and a thread range.
806 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
808 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
809
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200810crt-base <dir>
811 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100812 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
813 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200814
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200815daemon
816 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
817 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100818 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
819 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200821deviceatlas-json-file <path>
822 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100823 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200824
825deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100826 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200827 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
828
829deviceatlas-separator <char>
830 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
831 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
832
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100833deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200834 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
835 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
836 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100837
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900838external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100839 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
840 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100841 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
842 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
843 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
844 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
845 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200847gid <number>
848 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
849 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
850 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100851 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
852 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200853 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100854
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100855group <group name>
856 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
857 See also "gid" and "user".
858
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100859hard-stop-after <time>
860 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
861
862 Arguments :
863 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
864 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
865 SIGUSR1 signal.
866
867 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
868 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
869 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
870
871 Example:
872 global
873 hard-stop-after 30s
874
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200875h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
876 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
877 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
878 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
879 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500880 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200881 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
882 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
883 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
884 specified in a proxy.
885
886 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
887 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
888 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
889 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
890 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
891 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
892 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
893
894 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
895 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
896 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
897 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
898 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
899
900 Example:
901 global
902 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
903
904 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
905 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
906
907h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
908 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
909 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
910 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
911 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
912 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
913 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
914 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
915 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
916
917 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
918 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
919 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
920
921 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
922 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
923
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100924insecure-fork-wanted
925 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
926 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
927 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
928 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
929 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
930 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
931 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
932 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
933 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
934 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
935 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
936 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
937 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
938 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
939 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
940 disable it.
941
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100942insecure-setuid-wanted
943 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
944 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
945 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
946 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
947 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
948 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
949 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
950 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
951 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
952 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
953 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
954 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
955 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
956 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
957
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100958issuers-chain-path <dir>
959 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
960 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
961 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
962 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
963 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
964 "issuers-chain-path".
965 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
966 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
967 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
968 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
969 will share the chain in memory.
970
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200971log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
972 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100973 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100974 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100975 configured with "log global".
976
977 <address> can be one of:
978
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100979 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100980 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
981 port).
982
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100983 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
984 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
985 port).
986
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100987 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100988 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
989 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100990 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100992 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
993 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
994 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
995 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
996 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
997 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
998 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
999 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1000 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1001 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1002 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1003 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1004 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1005 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001006 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1007 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001008
1009 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1010 "fd@2", see above.
1011
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001012 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1013 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1014 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1015 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1016 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1017
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001018 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1019 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001020
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001021 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1022 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1023 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1024 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1025 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1026 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1027 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1028 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1029 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1030 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1032 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001033
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001034 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1035 one of the following :
1036
1037 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1038 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1039
1040 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1041 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1042
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001043 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1044 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1045 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1046 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1047 logger consumes.
1048
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001049 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1050 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1051 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1052 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1053
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001054 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1055 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1056 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1057 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1058 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1059
1060 <sample_size>
1061 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1062 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1063 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1064 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1065 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1066
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001067 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001069 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1070 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1071 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1072
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001073 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1074 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1075 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1076 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001077
1078 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001079 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1080 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1081 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1082 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1083 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1084 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001085
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001086 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001087
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001088log-send-hostname [<string>]
1089 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1090 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1091 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1092 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1093 the logs.
1094
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001095log-tag <string>
1096 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1097 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1098 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001099 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001100
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001101lua-load <file>
1102 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1103 used multiple times.
1104
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001105lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1106 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1107 variable.
1108 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1109 to "path".
1110
1111 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1112 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1113 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1114 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1115 will be checked earlier.
1116
1117 As an example by specifying the following path:
1118
1119 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1120 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1121
1122 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1123 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1124 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1125 paths if that does not exist either.
1126
1127 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1128 documentation.
1129
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001130master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001131 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1132 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1133 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001134 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001135 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1136 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001137 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1138 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1139 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1140 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1141 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001142
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001143 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001144
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001145mworker-max-reloads <number>
1146 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001147 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001148 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1149 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1150 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1151
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001152nbproc <number>
1153 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1154 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1155 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001156 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1157 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001158 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1159 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001160
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001161nbthread <number>
1162 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001163 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1164 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1165 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1166 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1167 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001168 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1169 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1170 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1171 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1172 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1173 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1174 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001175
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001176pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001177 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001178 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1179 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1180
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001181presetenv <name> <value>
1182 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1183 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1184 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1185 and "unsetenv".
1186
1187resetenv [<name> ...]
1188 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1189 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1190 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1191 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1192 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1193 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1194 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1195 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1196
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001197stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001198 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1199 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1200 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1201 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1202 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1203 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001204 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001205 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1206 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1207 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1208 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001209
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001210server-state-base <directory>
1211 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001212 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1213 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001214
1215server-state-file <file>
1216 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1217 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1218 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1219 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1220 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1221 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1222 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1223 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001224 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1225 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001226
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001227setenv <name> <value>
1228 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1229 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1230 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1231 and "unsetenv".
1232
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001233set-dumpable
1234 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001235 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1236 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1237 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1238 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1239 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1240 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1241 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1242 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1243 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1244 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1245 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1246 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1247 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1248 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1249 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1250 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1251 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001252
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001253ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1255 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001256 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001257 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001258 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1259 information and recommendations see e.g.
1260 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1261 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1262 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1263 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001264
1265ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1267 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1268 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1269 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1270 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001271 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1272 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1273 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001274 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001275
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001276ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1278 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1279 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1280 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1281 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1282
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001283ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1285 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1286 keyword to see available options.
1287
1288 Example:
1289 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001290 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001291
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001292ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1294 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001295 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001296 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001297 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1298 information and recommendations see e.g.
1299 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1300 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1301 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1302 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1303 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001304
1305ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1307 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1308 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1309 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1310 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001311 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1312 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1313 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1314 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001315
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001316ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1318 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1319 keyword to see available options.
1320
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001321ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1323 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1324 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001325 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001326 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001327 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1328 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1329 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1330 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001331 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1332 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1333 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1334
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001335ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001336 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1337 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1338
1339 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1340 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1341 optimize the startup time.
1342
1343 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1344 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1345 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1346
1347 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001348 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001349
1350 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1351 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1352 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1353 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1354 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1355 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001356 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001357 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1358
1359 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1360
1361 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1362
1363 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1364 not provided in the PEM file.
1365
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001366 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1367 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1368
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001369 The default behavior is "all".
1370
1371 Example:
1372 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1373 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1374 ssl-load-extra-files none
1375
1376 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1377
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001378ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1379 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1380 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1381 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1382
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001383ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1384 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1385 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1386 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1387 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1388 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1389 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1390 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1391 bits does not need it.
1392
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001393stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1394 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1395 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1396 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001397 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001398 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001399
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001400 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1401 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1402 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001403
1404stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1405 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1406 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001407 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001408
1409stats maxconn <connections>
1410 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1411 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1412
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001413uid <number>
1414 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1415 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1416 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1417 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1418
1419ulimit-n <number>
1420 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1421 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1422 option.
1423
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001424unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1425 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1426
1427 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1428 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1429 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1430 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1431 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1432 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1433 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1434 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1435 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1436 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1437
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001438unsetenv [<name> ...]
1439 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1440 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1441 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1442 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1443 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1444 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1445 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1446
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001447user <user name>
1448 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1449 See also "uid" and "group".
1450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001451node <name>
1452 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1453
1454 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1455 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1456 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1457 traffic.
1458
1459description <text>
1460 Add a text that describes the instance.
1461
1462 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1463 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1464 "<" and ">" characters.
1465
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100146651degrees-data-file <file path>
1467 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001468 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001469
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001470 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001471 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1472
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000147351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001474 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1475 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1476 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1477
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001478 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001479 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1480
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200148151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001482 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1483 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1484
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001485 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1486 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1487
148851degrees-cache-size <number>
1489 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1490 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1491 By default, this cache is disabled.
1492
1493 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001494 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1495
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001496wurfl-data-file <file path>
1497 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1498 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1499
1500 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1501 with USE_WURFL=1.
1502
1503wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1504 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1505 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1506 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1507
1508 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1509
1510 Valid WURFL properties are:
1511 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1512
1513 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1514 device.
1515
1516 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1517 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1518
1519 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1520 particular web request.
1521
1522 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1523 used Libwurfl API version.
1524
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001525 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1526 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1527
1528 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1529 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1530
1531 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1532
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001533 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1534 with USE_WURFL=1.
1535
1536wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1537 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1538 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1539
1540 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1541 with USE_WURFL=1.
1542
1543wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1544 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1545 thus before the chroot.
1546
1547 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1548 with USE_WURFL=1.
1549
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001550wurfl-cache-size <size>
1551 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1552 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001553 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001554 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001555
1556 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1557 with USE_WURFL=1.
1558
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001559strict-limits
1560 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1561 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1562 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1563 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1564 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1565 keyword.
1566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015673.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001568-----------------------
1569
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001570busy-polling
1571 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1572 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1573 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1574 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1575 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1576 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1577 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1578 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1579 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1580 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1581 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1582 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1583 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1584 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1585 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1586 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1587 "poll" pollers.
1588
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001589 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1590 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1591 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1592
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001593max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1594 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1595 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1596 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1597 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1598 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1599 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1600 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1601 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1602
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603maxconn <number>
1604 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1605 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1606 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001607 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1608 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1609 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1610 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001611 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1612 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1613 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1614 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1615 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1616 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001617
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001618maxconnrate <number>
1619 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1620 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1621 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1622 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1623 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1624 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1625 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1626 fairness.
1627
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001628maxcomprate <number>
1629 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001630 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001631 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1632 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1633 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001634 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001635 default value.
1636
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001637maxcompcpuusage <number>
1638 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1639 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1640 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1641 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1642 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1643 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1644 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1645 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1646
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001647maxpipes <number>
1648 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1649 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1650 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1651 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1652 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1653 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1654
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001655maxsessrate <number>
1656 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1657 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1658 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1659 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1660 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1661 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1662 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1663 fairness.
1664
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001665maxsslconn <number>
1666 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1667 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1668 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1669 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1670 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1671 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1672 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001673 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1674 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1675 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1676 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1677 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1678 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1679 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001680
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001681maxsslrate <number>
1682 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1683 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1684 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1685 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1686 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1687 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1688 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1689 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1690 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1691 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1692
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001693maxzlibmem <number>
1694 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1695 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1696 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001697 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1698 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1699 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701noepoll
1702 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1703 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001704 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001705
1706nokqueue
1707 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1708 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1709 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1710
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001711noevports
1712 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1713 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1714 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1715 also "nopoll".
1716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001717nopoll
1718 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1719 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001720 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001721 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1722 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001723
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001724nosplice
1725 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001726 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001727 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001728 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001729 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1730 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1731 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1732 "option splice-response".
1733
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001734nogetaddrinfo
1735 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1736 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1737
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001738noreuseport
1739 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1740 command line argument "-dR".
1741
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001742profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1743 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1744 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1745 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1746 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001747 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001748 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1749 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1750 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1751 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1752
1753 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1754 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1755 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1756 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1757 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001758 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1759 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1760 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1761 CLI.
1762
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001763spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001764 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1765 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1766 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1767 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1768 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1769 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001771ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001772 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001773 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001774 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1775 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1776 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1777 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1778 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001779 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1780 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001781 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1782 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1783 openssl configuration file uses:
1784 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1785
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001786ssl-mode-async
1787 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001788 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001789 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1790 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1791 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001792 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001793 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001794
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001795tune.buffers.limit <number>
1796 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1797 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1798 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1799 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1800 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001801 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001802 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1803 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1804 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1805 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1806 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1807 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1808 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1809 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1810 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1811
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001812tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1813 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1814 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1815 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1816 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1817
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001818tune.bufsize <number>
1819 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1820 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1821 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1822 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1823 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1824 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1825 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001826 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1827 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1828 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001829 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001830 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1831 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1832 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001833
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001834tune.chksize <number>
1835 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1836 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1837 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1838 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1839 checks whenever possible.
1840
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001841tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1842 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1843 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1844 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1845 this value. The default value is 1.
1846
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001847tune.fail-alloc
1848 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1849 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1850 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1851 gracefully.
1852
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001853tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1854 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1855 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1856 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1857 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1858 change it.
1859
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001860tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1861 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001862 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1863 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001864 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1865 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1866 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1867 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1868 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1869
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001870tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1871 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1872 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1873 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1874 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1875 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1876 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1877 recommended not to change this value.
1878
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001879tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1880 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1881 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1882 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1883 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1884 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1885 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1886 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1887
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001888tune.http.cookielen <number>
1889 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1890 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1891 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1892 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1893 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1894 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1895 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1896 to change this value.
1897
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001898tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001899 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1900 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001901 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001902 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001903 configuration directives too.
1904 The default value is 1024.
1905
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001906tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1907 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1908 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1909 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1910 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1911 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1912 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001913 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1914 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1915 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001916
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001917tune.idletimer <timeout>
1918 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1919 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1920 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1921 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1922 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1923 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001924 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001925 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001926 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1927
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001928tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1929 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1930 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1931 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1932 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1933 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1934 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1935 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1936 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1937 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1938
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001939tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1940 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001941 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001942 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1943 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001944 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001945 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1946 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1947
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001948tune.lua.maxmem
1949 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1950 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1951 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1952 memory.
1953
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001954tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1955 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001956 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1957 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001958 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001959
1960tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1961 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1962 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1963 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1964 check servers.
1965
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001966tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1967 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1968 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1969 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001970 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001971
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001972tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001973 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1974 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1975 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1976 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1977 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1978 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1979 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1980 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1981 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1982 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001983
1984tune.maxpollevents <number>
1985 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1986 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1987 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1988 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1989 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1990
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001991tune.maxrewrite <number>
1992 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1993 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1994 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1995 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1996 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1997 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1998 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1999 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2000 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2001 bufsize.
2002
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002003tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2004 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2005 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2006 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2007 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2008 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2009 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2010 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2011 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2012 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002013 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2014 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002015 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2016 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2017 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2018 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2019 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2020 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2021 setting this parameter to 0.
2022
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002023tune.pipesize <number>
2024 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2025 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2026 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2027 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2028 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2029 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2030
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002031tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2032 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2033 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2034 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2035 default is 20.
2036
2037tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2038 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2039 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2040 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2041 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2042 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2043 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002044 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002045
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002046tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2047tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2048 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2049 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2050 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002051 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002052 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002053 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2054 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2055
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002056tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002057 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002058 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2059 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2060 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2061 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2062
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002063tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002064 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002065 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2066 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2067
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002068tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2069tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2070 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2071 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2072 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002073 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002074 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002075 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2076 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2077 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2078 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2079 notifying haproxy again.
2080
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002081tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002082 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2083 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2084 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002085 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002086 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002087 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002088 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2089 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2090 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002091 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2092 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002093
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002094tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002095 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002096 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2097 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2098 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2099 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2100 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2101
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002102tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2103 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002104 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002105 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2106 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2107 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2108 being used for too long.
2109
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002110tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2111 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2112 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2113 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2114 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2115 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2116 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2117 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2118 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2119 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2120 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002121 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002122 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002123
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002124tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2125 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2126 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2127 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2128 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2129 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2130 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2131 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002132 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2133 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002134
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002135tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2136 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2137 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2138 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2139 1000 entries.
2140
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002141tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2142 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2143 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2144 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2145
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002146tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002147tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002148tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2149tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2150tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002151 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2152 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2153 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2154 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2155 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2156 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2157 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2158 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002159
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002160 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2161 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2162 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2163 all available space is consumed.
2164 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2165 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2166 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002167
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002168tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2169 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002170 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002171 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002172 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002173 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2174
2175tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2176 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2177 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002178 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2179 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021813.3. Debugging
2182--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002183
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002184debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002185 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2186 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2187 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2188 system startup.
2189
2190quiet
2191 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2192 line argument "-q".
2193
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002194zero-warning
2195 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2196 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2197 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2198 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2199 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2200 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2201
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022033.4. Userlists
2204--------------
2205It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2206http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2207it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2208
2209userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002210 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002211 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2212
2213group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002214 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002215 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2216 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2217
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002218user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2219 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002220 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2221 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002222 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2223 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2224 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2225 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002226
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002227 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2228 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2229 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2230 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2231 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2232 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2233 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2234 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2235 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002236
2237 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002238 userlist L1
2239 group G1 users tiger,scott
2240 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002241
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002242 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2243 user scott insecure-password elgato
2244 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002245
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002246 userlist L2
2247 group G1
2248 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002249
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002250 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2251 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2252 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002253
2254 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002255
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002256
22573.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002258----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002259It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2260several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2261instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2262values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2263automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2264In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2265using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2266tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2267reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2268Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2269that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2270each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002271
2272peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002273 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002274 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2275
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002276bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2277 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2278 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2279
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002280disabled
2281 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2282 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2283 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2284
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002285default-bind [param*]
2286 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2287
2288default-server [param*]
2289 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2290
2291 Arguments:
2292 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2293 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2294 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2295 details.
2296
2297
2298 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2299
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002300enable
2301 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2302
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002303log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2304 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2305 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2306 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2307 more details.
2308
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002309peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002310 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2311 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2312 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2313 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2314 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2315 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2316
2317 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2318 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2319
2320 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2321 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2322 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2323 across all peers.
2324
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002325 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2326 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002327
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002328 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2329 "server" keyword explanation below).
2330
2331server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002332 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002333 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2334 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2335 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2336 of this "peers" section).
2337 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2338
2339
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002340 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002341 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002342 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002343 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2344 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2345 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002346
2347 backend mybackend
2348 mode tcp
2349 balance roundrobin
2350 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2351 stick on src
2352
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002353 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2354 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002355
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002356 Example:
2357 peers mypeers
2358 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2359 default-server ssl verify none
2360 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2361 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002362
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002363
2364table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2365 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2366
2367 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2368 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002369 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002370 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2371 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2372 "stick-table" keyword).
2373
2374 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2375 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2376 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2377 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2378 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2379 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2380 of the stick-table name as follows:
2381
2382 peers mypeers
2383 peer A ...
2384 peer B ...
2385 table t1 ...
2386
2387 frontend fe1
2388 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2389
2390 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2391 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2392
2393 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2394 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2395 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2396 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2397 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2398 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2399 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2400
2401 peers mypeers
2402 peer A ...
2403 peer B ...
2404 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2405
2406 backend t1
2407 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2408
2409 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2410 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2411 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2412
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024133.6. Mailers
2414------------
2415It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2416If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2417in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2418
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002419mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002420 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2421 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2422
2423mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2424 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2425
2426 Example:
2427 mailers mymailers
2428 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2429 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2430
2431 backend mybackend
2432 mode tcp
2433 balance roundrobin
2434
2435 email-alert mailers mymailers
2436 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2437 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2438
2439 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2440 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2441
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002442timeout mail <time>
2443 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2444 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2445 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2446 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2447
2448 Example:
2449 mailers mymailers
2450 timeout mail 20s
2451 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002452
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024533.7. Programs
2454-------------
2455In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2456master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2457managed the same way as the workers.
2458
2459During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2460sequence as a worker:
2461
2462 - the master is re-executed
2463 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2464 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2465 instance of the program
2466
2467During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2468
2469program <name>
2470 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2471 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2472 the management guide).
2473
2474command <command> [arguments*]
2475 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2476 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2477 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2478 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2479
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002480user <user name>
2481 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2482 See also "group".
2483
2484group <group name>
2485 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2486 See also "user".
2487
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002488option start-on-reload
2489no option start-on-reload
2490 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2491 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2492 program section.
2493
2494
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024953.8. HTTP-errors
2496----------------
2497
2498It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2499imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2500several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2501
2502http-errors <name>
2503 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2504 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2505
2506errorfile <code> <file>
2507 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2508
2509 Arguments :
2510 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2511 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2512 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2513
2514 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2515 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2516 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2517 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2518 before any chroot is performed.
2519
2520 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2521
2522 Example:
2523 http-errors website-1
2524 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2525 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2526 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2527
2528 http-errors website-2
2529 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2530 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2531 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2532
2533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025344. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002535----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002536
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002537Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002538 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002539 - frontend <name>
2540 - backend <name>
2541 - listen <name>
2542
2543A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2544its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2545section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002546section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002547
2548A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2549connections.
2550
2551A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2552to forward incoming connections.
2553
2554A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2555parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002557All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2558'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2559case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2560
2561Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2562logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2563proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2564However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2565name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2566
2567Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2568and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002569bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002570protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2571modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2572arbitrary criteria.
2573
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002574In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2575a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002576the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002577
2578 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2579 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2580 between responses and new requests.
2581
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002582 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2583 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2584 client-facing connection remains open.
2585
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002586 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2587 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002588
2589The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2590frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2591following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002592weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002593
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002594 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002595
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002596 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2597 ----+-----+-----+----
2598 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2599 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002600 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2601 ----+-----+-----+----
2602 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002603
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002604
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026064.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2607--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002609The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2610limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2611they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2612limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002613marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002614option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002615and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2616with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2617specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002619
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002620 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2621------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2622acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623backlog X X X -
2624balance X - X X
2625bind - X X -
2626bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002627capture cookie - X X -
2628capture request header - X X -
2629capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002630compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002631cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002632declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002633default-server X - X X
2634default_backend X X X -
2635description - X X X
2636disabled X X X X
2637dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002638email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002639email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002640email-alert mailers X X X X
2641email-alert myhostname X X X X
2642email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002643enabled X X X X
2644errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002645errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002646errorloc X X X X
2647errorloc302 X X X X
2648-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2649errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002650force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002651filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002652fullconn X - X X
2653grace X X X X
2654hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002655http-after-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002656http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002657http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002658http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002659http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002660http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002661http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002662http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002663id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002664ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002665load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002666log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002667log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002668log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002669log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002670max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002671maxconn X X X -
2672mode X X X X
2673monitor fail - X X -
2674monitor-net X X X -
2675monitor-uri X X X -
2676option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2677option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2678option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2679option allbackups (*) X - X X
2680option checkcache (*) X - X X
2681option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2682option contstats (*) X X X -
2683option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2684option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002685-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2686option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002687option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2688option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002689option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002690option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002691option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002692option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002693option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002694option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2695option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2696option httpchk X - X X
2697option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002698option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002699option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002700option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002701option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002702option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002703option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2704option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2705option logasap (*) X X X -
2706option mysql-check X - X X
2707option nolinger (*) X X X X
2708option originalto X X X X
2709option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002710option pgsql-check X - X X
2711option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002712option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002713option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002714option smtpchk X - X X
2715option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2716option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2717option splice-request (*) X X X X
2718option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002719option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002720option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2721option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2722-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002723option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002724option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2725option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2726option tcpka X X X X
2727option tcplog X X X X
2728option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002729external-check command X - X X
2730external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002731persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2732rate-limit sessions X X X -
2733redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002734-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002735retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002736retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002737server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002738server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002739server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002740source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002741stats admin - X X X
2742stats auth X X X X
2743stats enable X X X X
2744stats hide-version X X X X
2745stats http-request - X X X
2746stats realm X X X X
2747stats refresh X X X X
2748stats scope X X X X
2749stats show-desc X X X X
2750stats show-legends X X X X
2751stats show-node X X X X
2752stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002753-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2754stick match - - X X
2755stick on - - X X
2756stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002757stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002758stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002759tcp-check connect - - X X
2760tcp-check expect - - X X
2761tcp-check send - - X X
2762tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01002763tcp-check set-var - - X X
2764tcp-check unset-var - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002765tcp-request connection - X X -
2766tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002767tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002768tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002769tcp-response content - - X X
2770tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002771timeout check X - X X
2772timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002773timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002774timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002775timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2776timeout http-request X X X X
2777timeout queue X - X X
2778timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002779timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002780timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002781timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002782transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002783unique-id-format X X X -
2784unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002785use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002786use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002787use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002788------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2789 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002790
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002791
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027924.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2793---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002794
2795This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2796
2797
2798acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2799 Declare or complete an access list.
2800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2801 no | yes | yes | yes
2802 Example:
2803 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2804 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2805 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002807 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002808
2809
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002810backlog <conns>
2811 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2813 yes | yes | yes | no
2814 Arguments :
2815 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2816 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002817 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002818
2819 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2820 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2821 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2822 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2823 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2824 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2825 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2826 backlog parameter.
2827
2828 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2829 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2830 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2831
2832 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2833
2834
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002836balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002837 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2839 yes | no | yes | yes
2840 Arguments :
2841 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2842 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2843 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2844 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2845
2846 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2847 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2848 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2849 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002850 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002851 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002852 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2853 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2854 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2855 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2856 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2857 it, so that you don't worry.
2858
2859 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2860 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2861 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2862 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2863 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2864 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2865 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2866 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002867
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002868 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2869 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2870 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2871 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2872 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2873 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2874 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2875 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2876
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002877 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002878 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002879 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2880 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002881 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002882 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2883 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2884 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2885 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2886 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002887 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2888 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2889 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2890 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2891 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2892 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002893
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002894 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2895 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2896 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2897 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2898 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2899 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2900 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2901 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002902 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002903 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002904 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2905 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2906 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002907
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002908 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2909 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2910 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2911 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2912 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2913 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2914 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2915 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2916 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2917 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2918 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2919 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002920
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002921 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002922 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2923 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2924 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2925 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2926 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2927 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2928 URIs start with a leading "/".
2929
2930 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2931 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2932 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2933 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002935 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002936 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2937
2938 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002939 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2940 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002941 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2942 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2943 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2944 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002945 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002946 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2947 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002948
2949 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2950 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2951 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2952 server will receive the request.
2953
2954 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2955 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2956 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2957 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2958 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002959 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2960 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2961 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002962
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002963 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2964 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2965 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2966 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2967 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002968
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002969 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002970 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2971 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2972 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2973
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002974 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2975 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2976 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2977
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002978 random
2979 random(<draws>)
2980 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002981 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2982 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2983 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2984 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002985 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2986 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2987 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2988 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2989 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2990 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2991 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2992 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2993 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2994 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2995 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2996 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2997 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2998 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2999 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3000 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3001 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3002 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3003 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3004 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003005
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003006 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003007 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003008 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3009 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3010 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3011 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3012 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3013 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003014 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003015 used instead.
3016
3017 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3018 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3019 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3020 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3021
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003022 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3023 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3024 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3025
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003026 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003027
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003028 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003029 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3030 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003031
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003032 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3033 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3034 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003035
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003036 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003037 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003038 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3039 NTLM relies on.
3040
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003041 Examples :
3042 balance roundrobin
3043 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003044 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003045 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3046 balance hdr(host)
3047 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003048
3049 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3050 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3051
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003052 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003053 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3054 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3055 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003056 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003057
3058 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3059 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3060 defaults to 16 kB.
3061
3062 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3063 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3064
3065 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3066 Round Robin.
3067
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003068 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003069 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3070 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3071 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3072
3073 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3074
3075 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003076 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003077 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3078 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3079 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003080
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003081 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082
3083
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003084bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3085bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003086 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3088 no | yes | yes | no
3089 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003090 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3091 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3092 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3093 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003094 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003095 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3096 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3097 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3098 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3099 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3100 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3101 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003102 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3103 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3104 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3105 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3106 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3107 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3108 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003109 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3110 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3111 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003112 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3113 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3114 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3115 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003116 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3117 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3118 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003119
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003120 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3121 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003122 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3123 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3124 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003125 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3126 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3127 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3128 the range.
3129
3130 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3131 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3132 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3133 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3134 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3135 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3136 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003137 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003138 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003139
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003140 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003141 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003142 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3143 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3144 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3145 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3146 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3147 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3148
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003149 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3150 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3151 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3152 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003153
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003154 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3155 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3156 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3157 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3158 in a frontend.
3159
3160 Example :
3161 listen http_proxy
3162 bind :80,:443
3163 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003164 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003165
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003166 listen http_https_proxy
3167 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003168 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003169
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003170 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3171 bind ipv6@:80
3172 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3173 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3174
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003175 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003176 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003177
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003178 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3179 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3180 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3181 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3182 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3183
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003184 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003185 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003186
3187
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003188bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003189 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3191 yes | yes | yes | yes
3192 Arguments :
3193 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3194 may be used to override a default value.
3195
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003196 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003197 option may be combined with other numbers.
3198
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003199 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003200 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3201 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3202 missing from all processes.
3203
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003204 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003205 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003206 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3207 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3208 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3209 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3210 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003211 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003212
3213 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3214 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3215 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3216 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3217 and 'even' instances.
3218
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003219 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3220 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3221 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3222 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003223
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003224 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3225 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3226
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003227 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3228 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3229 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3230
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003231 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3232 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3233
3234 Example :
3235 listen app_ip1
3236 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003237 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003238
3239 listen app_ip2
3240 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003241 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003242
3243 listen management
3244 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003245 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003246
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003247 listen management
3248 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3249 bind-process 1-4
3250
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003251 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003252
3253
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003254capture cookie <name> len <length>
3255 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3257 no | yes | yes | no
3258 Arguments :
3259 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3260 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3261 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3262 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003263 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003264
3265 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3266 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3267 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3268 right if it exceeds <length>.
3269
3270 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3271 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3272 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3273 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3274
3275 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3276 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3277 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3278
3279 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3280 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3281 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003282 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3283 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3284 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003285
3286 Example:
3287 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3288
3289 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003290 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003291
3292
3293capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003294 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3296 no | yes | yes | no
3297 Arguments :
3298 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003299 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3301 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3302 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3303
3304 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3305 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3306 it exceeds <length>.
3307
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003308 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003309 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3310 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003311 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3312 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3313 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3314 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003315 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003316 environments to find where the request came from.
3317
3318 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3319 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3320 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3321 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003322
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003323 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3324 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3325 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3326 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3327 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003328
3329 Example:
3330 capture request header Host len 15
3331 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003332 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003334 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003335 about logging.
3336
3337
3338capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003339 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3341 no | yes | yes | no
3342 Arguments :
3343 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003344 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003345 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3346 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3347 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3348
3349 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3350 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3351 it exceeds <length>.
3352
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003353 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003354 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3355 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3356 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003357 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3358 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3359 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3360 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003361
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003362 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3363 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3364 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3365 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3366 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003367
3368 Example:
3369 capture response header Content-length len 9
3370 capture response header Location len 15
3371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003372 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003373 about logging.
3374
3375
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003376compression algo <algorithm> ...
3377compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003378compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003379 Enable HTTP compression.
3380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3381 yes | yes | yes | yes
3382 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003383 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3384 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3385 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3386
3387 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003388 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3389 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3390 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003391
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003392 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003393 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003394
3395 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3396 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3397 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3398 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3399 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003400 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003401
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003402 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3403 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3404 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3405 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3406 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3407 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3408 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003409 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003410
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003411 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003412 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003413 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3414 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3415 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3416 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3417 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003418
3419 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3420 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3421 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3422 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3423 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003424 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3425 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3426 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3427 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3428 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003429 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3430 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003431
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003432 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003433 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3434 "Accept-Encoding" header
3435 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003436 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003437 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3438 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3439 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3440 "multipart"
3441 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3442 header
3443 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3444 and later
3445 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3446 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003447 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003448
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003449 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003450
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003451 Examples :
3452 compression algo gzip
3453 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003454
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003455
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003456cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003457 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3458 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003459 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003460 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3462 yes | no | yes | yes
3463 Arguments :
3464 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3465 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3466 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3467 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3468 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3469 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003470 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003471 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3472 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3473
3474 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3475 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3476 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3477 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3478 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3479 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003480 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3481 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003482 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003483 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3484 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003485
3486 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003487 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003488
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003489 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003490 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003491 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003492 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003493 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3494 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3495 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3496 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3497 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3498 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3499 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003500
3501 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3502 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3503 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3504 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3505 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3506 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3507 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3508 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3509 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003510 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003511 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3512 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3513 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003514
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003515 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3516 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3517 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003518 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3519 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3520 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3521 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003522 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3523 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3524 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003525
3526 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3527 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3528 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3529 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3530 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3531 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3532 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3533 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3534 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3535
3536 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3537 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3538 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3539 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3540 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3541 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3542 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3543 persistence cookie in the cache.
3544 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3545
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003546 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3547 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3548 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3549 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3550 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003551 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003552 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3553 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3554 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3555 they logout.
3556
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003557 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3558 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3559 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3560 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3561
3562 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3563 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3564 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3565 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3566 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3567 this attribute.
3568
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003569 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003570 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003571 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3572 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3573 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3574 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3575 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3576 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003577
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003578 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3579 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3580 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3581 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3582 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3583 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3584 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3585 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003586 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003587 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3588 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3589 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3590 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3591 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3592 the site.
3593
3594 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3595 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3596 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3597 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3598 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3599 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3600 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3601 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3602 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3603 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3604 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3605 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3606 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003607 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003608 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3609 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3610
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003611 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3612 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3613 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3614 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3615 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3616 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3617
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003618 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3619 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3620 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3621 repeated.
3622
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003623 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3624 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3625 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3626 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003628 Examples :
3629 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3630 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3631 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003632 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003633
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003634 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003635
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003636
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003637declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3638 Declares a capture slot.
3639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3640 no | yes | yes | no
3641 Arguments:
3642 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3643
3644 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3645 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3646 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3647 for use in the response.
3648
3649 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003650 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003651 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3652
3653
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003654default-server [param*]
3655 Change default options for a server in a backend
3656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3657 yes | no | yes | yes
3658 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003659 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3660 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3661 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3662 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003663
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003664 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003665 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3666
3667 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003668
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003669
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003670default_backend <backend>
3671 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3673 yes | yes | yes | no
3674 Arguments :
3675 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3676
3677 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3678 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3679 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3680 will catch all undetermined requests.
3681
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003682 Example :
3683
3684 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3685 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3686 default_backend dynamic
3687
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003688 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003689
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003690
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003691description <string>
3692 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3694 no | yes | yes | yes
3695 Arguments : string
3696
3697 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3698 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3699 it describes.
3700 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3701
3702
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003703disabled
3704 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3706 yes | yes | yes | yes
3707 Arguments : none
3708
3709 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3710 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3711 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3712 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3713 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3714 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3715 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3716
3717 See also : "enabled"
3718
3719
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003720dispatch <address>:<port>
3721 Set a default server address
3722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3723 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003724 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003725
3726 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3727 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3728 during start-up.
3729
3730 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3731 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3732 possible with normal servers.
3733
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003734 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003735 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3736 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3737 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3738 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3739
3740 See also : "server"
3741
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003742
3743dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3744 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3746 yes | no | yes | yes
3747 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3748
3749 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003750 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003751 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3752 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003753 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003754 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003755
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003756enabled
3757 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3759 yes | yes | yes | yes
3760 Arguments : none
3761
3762 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3763 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3764
3765 See also : "disabled"
3766
3767
3768errorfile <code> <file>
3769 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3771 yes | yes | yes | yes
3772 Arguments :
3773 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003774 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3775 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003776
3777 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003778 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003779 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003780 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3781 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003782
3783 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3784 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3785 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3786
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003787 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3788
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003789 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3790 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3791 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3792 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3793
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003794 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3795 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003796 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003797 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3798 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3799 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3800
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003801 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3802 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3803 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003804 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003805 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3806
3807 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3808
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003809 Example :
3810 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003811 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003812 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3813 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3814
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003815
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003816errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3817 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3818 section.
3819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3820 yes | yes | yes | yes
3821 Arguments :
3822 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3823
3824 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3825 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3826 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3827
3828 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3829 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3830 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3831 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3832 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3833 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3834 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3835
3836 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3837 3.8 about http-errors.
3838
3839 Example :
3840 errorfiles generic
3841 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3842
3843
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003844errorloc <code> <url>
3845errorloc302 <code> <url>
3846 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3848 yes | yes | yes | yes
3849 Arguments :
3850 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003851 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3852 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003853
3854 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3855 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3856 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3857 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003858 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003859
3860 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3861 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3862 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3863
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003864 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3865
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003866 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3867 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3868 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3869 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003870 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003871 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3872 request.
3873
3874 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3875
3876
3877errorloc303 <code> <url>
3878 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3880 yes | yes | yes | yes
3881 Arguments :
3882 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003883 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3884 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003885
3886 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3887 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3888 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3889 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003890 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003891
3892 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3893 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3894 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3895
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003896 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3897
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003898 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3899 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3900 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3901 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003902 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003903
3904 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3905
3906
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003907email-alert from <emailaddr>
3908 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003909 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003910 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3911 yes | yes | yes | yes
3912
3913 Arguments :
3914
3915 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3916
3917 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3918 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3919
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003920 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003921 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3922 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003923
3924
3925email-alert level <level>
3926 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3927 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3928 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3929 yes | yes | yes | yes
3930
3931 Arguments :
3932
3933 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3934 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3935 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3936
3937 By default level is alert
3938
3939 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3940 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3941 for the proxy.
3942
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003943 Alerts are sent when :
3944
3945 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3946 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3947 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3948 is notice or lower
3949 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3950 and a health check status update occurs
3951
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003952 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3953 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003954 section 3.6 about mailers.
3955
3956
3957email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3958 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3959 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3960 yes | yes | yes | yes
3961
3962 Arguments :
3963
3964 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3965
3966 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3967 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3968
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003969 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3970 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003971
3972
3973email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3974 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3975 mailers.
3976 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3977 yes | yes | yes | yes
3978
3979 Arguments :
3980
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003981 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003982
3983 By default the systems hostname is used.
3984
3985 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3986 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3987 for the proxy.
3988
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003989 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3990 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003991
3992
3993email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003994 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003995 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3996 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3997 yes | yes | yes | yes
3998
3999 Arguments :
4000
4001 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4002
4003 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4004 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4005
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004006 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004007 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4008
4009
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004010force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4011 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4012 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004013 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004014
4015 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4016 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4017 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4018 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4019 marked down for maintenance operations.
4020
4021 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4022 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4023 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4024 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4025 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4026 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4027 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4028 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4029 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4030
4031 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4032 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4033 is used.
4034
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004035 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004036 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004037
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004038
4039filter <name> [param*]
4040 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4042 no | yes | yes | yes
4043 Arguments :
4044 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4045 referenced in section 9.
4046
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004047 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004048 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004049 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4050 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004051
4052 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4053 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4054
4055 Example:
4056 listen
4057 bind *:80
4058
4059 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4060 filter compression
4061 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4062
4063 compression algo gzip
4064 compression offload
4065
4066 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4067
4068 See also : section 9.
4069
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004070
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004071fullconn <conns>
4072 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4074 yes | no | yes | yes
4075 Arguments :
4076 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4077 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4078
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004079 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004080 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004081 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004082 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4083 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4084 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4085 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4086 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004087 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004088
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004089 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4090 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004091 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4092 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4093 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004094
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004095 Example :
4096 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4097 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4098 # connections.
4099 backend dynamic
4100 fullconn 10000
4101 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4102 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4103
4104 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4105
4106
4107grace <time>
4108 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004110 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004111 Arguments :
4112 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4113 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4114 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4115
4116 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4117 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004118 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004119 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4120
4121 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4122 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4123 simplify it.
4124
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004125
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004126hash-balance-factor <factor>
4127 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4129 yes | no | no | yes
4130 Arguments :
4131 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4132 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004133 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004134
4135 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4136 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4137 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4138 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4139 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4140 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4141 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4142
4143 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4144 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4145 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4146 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4147 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4148
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004149 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4150 consistent hashing mechanism.
4151
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004152 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4153
4154
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004155hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004156 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4158 yes | no | yes | yes
4159 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004160 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4161 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004162
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004163 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4164 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4165 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4166 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4167 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4168 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4169 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4170 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4171 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4172 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004173
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004174 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4175 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4176 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4177 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4178 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4179 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4180 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4181 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4182 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4183 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4184 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4185 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4186 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004187 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4188 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004189
4190 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4191
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004192 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004193 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4194 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4195 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004196 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4197 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4198 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004199
4200 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4201 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004202 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4203 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4204 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4205 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4206
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004207 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4208 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4209 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4210 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4211 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4212 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4213 parameter.
4214
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004215 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4216 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4217 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4218 used on strings.
4219
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004220 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4221
4222 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4223 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4224 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4225 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4226 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4227 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4228 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4229 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4230 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4231 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4232 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4233 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004234
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004235 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4236 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4237 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004238
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004239 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004240
4241
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004242http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4243 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4244 ones).
4245
4246 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4247 no | yes | yes | yes
4248
4249 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4250 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4251 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4252 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4253 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4254 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4255
4256 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4257 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4258 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4259
4260 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4261 below.
4262
4263 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4264 instance.
4265
4266 Example:
4267 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4268 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4269 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4270
4271http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4272
4273 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4274 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4275 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4276 example, or to pass some internal information.
4277 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4278 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4279 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4280
4281http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4282
4283 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4284 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4285
4286http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4287
4288 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4289
4290http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4291 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4292
4293 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4294
4295 Example:
4296 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4297
4298 # applied to:
4299 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4300
4301 # outputs:
4302 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4303
4304 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4305
4306http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4307 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4308
4309 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4310
4311 Example:
4312 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4313
4314 # applied to:
4315 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4316
4317 # outputs:
4318 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4319
4320http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4321
4322 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4323 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4324 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4325
4326http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4327 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4328
4329 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4330 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4331 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4332 fallback.
4333
4334 Example:
4335 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4336 http-response set-status 431
4337 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4338 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4339
4340http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4341
4342 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4343 inline.
4344
4345 Arguments:
4346 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4347 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4348 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4349 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4350 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4351 (request and response)
4352 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4353 processing
4354 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4355 processing
4356 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4357 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4358 and '_'.
4359
4360 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4361 followed by some converters.
4362
4363 Example:
4364 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4365
4366http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4367
4368 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4369 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4370 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4371 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4372 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004373 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004374 processing.
4375
4376 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4377 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4378 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4379 rules evaluation.
4380
4381http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4382
4383 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4384 details about <var-name>.
4385
4386 Example:
4387 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4388
4389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004390http-check disable-on-404
4391 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004393 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004394 Arguments : none
4395
4396 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4397 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4398 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4399 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4400 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4401 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4402 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4403 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004404 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4405 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4406 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4407
4408 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4409
4410
4411http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004412 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004414 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004415 Arguments :
4416 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4417 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004418 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004419 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4420 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4421 details on the supported keywords.
4422
4423 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4424 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4425 with the usual backslash ('\').
4426
4427 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4428 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4429 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4430 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4431 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4432
4433 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004434 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004435 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4436 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4437 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4438
4439 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004440 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004441 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4442 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4443 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4444 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4445
4446 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004447 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004448 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4449 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4450 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4451 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4452 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004453 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004454 trace).
4455
4456 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004457 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004458 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4459 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4460 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4461 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4462 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004463 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004464
4465 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4466 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4467 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4468 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4469 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4470 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4471 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4472 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4473
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004474 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4475 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4476 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4477
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004478 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4479 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4480
4481 Examples :
4482 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004483 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004484
4485 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004486 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004487
4488 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004489 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004490
4491 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004492 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004493
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004494 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004495
4496
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004497http-check send [hdr <name> <value>]* [body <string>]
4498 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4499 health checks.
4500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4501 yes | no | yes | yes
4502 Arguments :
4503 hdr <name> <value> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4504 <name> and whose value is defined by <value> to the
4505 request sent during HTTP health checks.
4506
4507 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent
4508 sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4509 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added
4510 to the request.
4511
4512 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4513 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4514 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
4515 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. The old trick consisting to
4516 add headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
4517 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4518 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4519 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4520
4521 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect"
4522
4523
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004524http-check send-state
4525 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4527 yes | no | yes | yes
4528 Arguments : none
4529
4530 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4531 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4532 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4533 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4534 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4535
4536 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4537 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4538 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4539 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4540 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004541 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4542 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4543 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4544
4545 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4546 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4547 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4548
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004549 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4550 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4551 checked in multiple backends.
4552
4553 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4554 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4555
4556 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4557 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4558 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4559 one fails.
4560
4561 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4562 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4563 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4564
4565 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4566 server's queue.
4567
4568 Example of a header received by the application server :
4569 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4570 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4571
4572 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004574
4575http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004576 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4577
4578 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4579 no | yes | yes | yes
4580
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004581 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4582 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4583 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4584 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4585 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004587 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4588 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004590 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004592 Example:
4593 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4594 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4595 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004596
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004597 http-request allow if nagios
4598 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4599 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4600 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004602 Example:
4603 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4604 acl add path /addacl
4605 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004607 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004609 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4610 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004612 Example:
4613 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4614 acl setmap path /setmap
4615 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4620 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004621
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004622 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4623 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004627 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4628 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4629 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4630 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4631 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4632 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4633 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4634 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004636http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004638 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4639 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4640 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4641 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4642 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4643 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4644 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4645 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004647http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004649 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4650 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004651
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004652
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004653http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004655 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4656 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4657 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4658 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4659 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004661 Example:
4662 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4663 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004664
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004665http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004666
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004667 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004669http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4670 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004672 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4673 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4674 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4675 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4676 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4677 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4678 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4679 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4680 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004682 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4683 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4684 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004685 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4686
4687 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4688 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4689 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4690 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004692http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004694 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4695 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4696 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4697 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4698 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4699 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004700
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004701http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004702
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004703 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004704
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004705http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004707 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4708 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4709 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4710 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4711 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4712 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004713
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004714http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4715 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004717 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4718 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4719 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004720 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4721 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4722 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4723 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4724 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004725 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004726
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004727http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4728 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4729 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4730 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4731
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004732http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4733
4734 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4735 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4736 pointed by <resolvers>.
4737 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4738 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4739 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4740 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4741 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4742 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4743 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4744 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4745 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4746 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4747 to 0.0.0.0.
4748
4749 Example:
4750 resolvers mydns
4751 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4752 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4753 timeout retry 1s
4754 hold valid 10s
4755 hold nx 3s
4756 hold other 3s
4757 hold obsolete 0s
4758 accepted_payload_size 8192
4759
4760 frontend fe
4761 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4762 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4763 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4764
4765 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4766 # which mean DNS resolution error
4767 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4768
4769 default_backend be
4770
4771 backend b_503
4772 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4773 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4774 # 503 error page to end users
4775
4776 backend be
4777 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4778 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4779 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4780 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4781 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4782
4783 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4784 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4785
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004786http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4787
4788 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4789 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4790 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4791 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004792 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4793 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004794
4795 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4796
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004797http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004799 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4800 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4801 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4802 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4803 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004804
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004805http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004807 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4808 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4809 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4810 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004812http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4813 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004814
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004815 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004816 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4817 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4818 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4819 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4820 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004821
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004822 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4823 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4824 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4825 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4826 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004827
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004828 Example:
4829 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4830
4831 # applied to:
4832 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4833
4834 # outputs:
4835 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4836
4837 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004838
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004839 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4840
4841 # applied to:
4842 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004843
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004844 # outputs:
4845 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004846
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004847http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4848 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4849
4850 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4851 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4852 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4853 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4854
4855 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4856 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4857 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4858
4859 Example:
4860 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4861 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4862
4863 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4864 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4865
4866 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4867 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4868 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4869 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4870
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004871http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4872 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4873
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004874 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4875 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4876 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4877 against.
4878
4879 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4880 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4881 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004882
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004883 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4884 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4885 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4886 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4887 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4888 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4889 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4890 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4891 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004892 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4893 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004894
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004895 Example:
4896 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4897 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004898
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004899 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4900 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004901
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004902http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4903 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004904
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004905 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4906 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4907 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4908 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004909
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004910 Example:
4911 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004912
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004913 # applied to:
4914 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004915
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004916 # outputs:
4917 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004918
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004919http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
4920 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4921 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004922 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004923 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4924
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004925 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004926 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
4927 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
4928 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
4929 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004930 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004931 are followed to create the response :
4932
4933 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
4934 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
4935 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4936 ignored.
4937
4938 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
4939 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
4940 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
4941 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4942 ignored.
4943
4944 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
4945 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
4946 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
4947 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
4948 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
4949
4950 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
4951 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
4952 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
4953 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
4954 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
4955 if any, is ignored.
4956
4957 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
4958 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
4959 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
4960 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
4961 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
4962 as a raw content.
4963
4964 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
4965 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
4966 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
4967 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
4968 considered as a raw string.
4969
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004970 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
4971 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
4972 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
4973 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
4974
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004975 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
4976 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
4977 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
4978
4979 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4980
4981 Example:
4982 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
4983 if { path /ping }
4984
4985 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
4986 if { path /favicon.ico }
4987
4988 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
4989 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
4990 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
4991
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004992http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4993http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004994
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004995 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4996 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4997 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004998
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004999http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5000 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005001
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005002 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5003 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5004 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5005 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005006
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005007http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005009 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5010 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5011 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5012 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5013 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005014
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005015 Arguments:
5016 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5017 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005019 Example:
5020 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5021 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005023 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5024 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005026http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005027
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005028 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5029 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5030 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005032 Arguments:
5033 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5034 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005035
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005036 Example:
5037 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5038 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005039
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005040 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5041 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5042 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005044http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005045
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005046 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5047 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5048 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5049 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5050 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005052 Example:
5053 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5054 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5055 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5056 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5057 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5058 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5059 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5060 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5061 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005062
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005063http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005064
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005065 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5066 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5067 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5068 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5069 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005071http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5072 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005073
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005074 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5075 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5076 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5077 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5078 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5079 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5080 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5081 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5082 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005083
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005084http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005086 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5087 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5088 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5089 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5090 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5091 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5092 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005094http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005096 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5097 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5098 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005100http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005102 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5103 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5104 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5105 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5106 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5107 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5108 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5109 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005110
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005111http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005113 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5114 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5115 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5116 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5117 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5118 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005119
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005120 Example :
5121 # prepend the host name before the path
5122 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005124http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005126 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5127 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5128 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5129 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5130 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005131
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005132http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005133
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005134 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5135 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5136 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5137 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5138 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5139 values have higher priority.
5140 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5141 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5142 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5143 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5144 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005146http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005147
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005148 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5149 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5150 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5151 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5152 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5153 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5154 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005156 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005157
5158 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005159 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5160 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005162http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5163 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5164 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5165 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005166 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5167 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005168
5169 Arguments :
5170 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5171 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005172
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005173 See also "option forwardfor".
5174
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005175 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005176 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5177 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5178
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005179 # After the masking this will track connections
5180 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5181 http-request track-sc0 src
5182
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005183 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5184 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5185
5186http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5187
5188 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5189 expression.
5190
5191 Arguments:
5192 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5193 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005194
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005195 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005196 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5197 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5198
5199 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5200 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5201 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5202
5203http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5204
5205 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5206 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5207 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5208 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5209 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5210 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5211 information from the request.
5212
5213 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5214
5215http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5216
5217 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5218 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5219 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5220 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5221 path and the query string.
5222 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5223
5224http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5225
5226 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5227 inline.
5228
5229 Arguments:
5230 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5231 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5232 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5233 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5234 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5235 (request and response)
5236 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5237 processing
5238 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5239 processing
5240 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5241 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5242 and '_'.
5243
5244 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5245 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005246
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005247 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005248 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005250http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5251 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005252
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005253 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5254 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5255 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5256 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5257 agent name must be used.
5258
5259 Arguments:
5260 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5261
5262 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5263 configuration.
5264
5265http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5266
5267 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5268 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5269 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5270 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5271 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5272 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5273 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5274 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5275 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5276 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5277 action.
5278 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5279 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5280 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5281 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5282 you fully understand how it works.
5283
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005284http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5285
5286 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5287 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5288 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5289 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5290 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005291 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005292 processing.
5293
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005294 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005295 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5296 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5297 rules evaluation.
5298
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005299http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5300 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005301
5302 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5303 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5304 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5305 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5306 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5307 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5308 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5309 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5310 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5311 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5312 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005313 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5314 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5315 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5316 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5317 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005318 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5319
5320http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5321http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5322http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5323
5324 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5325 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5326 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5327 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5328 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5329 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5330 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5331 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5332 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5333 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5334 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5335 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5336
5337 Arguments :
5338 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5339 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5340 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5341 select which table entry to update the counters.
5342
5343 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5344 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5345 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5346 that table until the session ends.
5347
5348 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5349 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5350 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5351 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5352 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5353 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5354 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5355 useful information.
5356
5357 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5358 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5359 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5360 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5361 checks that make use of it.
5362
5363http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5364
5365 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005366
5367 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005368 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005369
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005370http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5371
5372 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5373 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5374 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5375 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5376 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5377 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5378
5379 Arguments :
5380 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5381
5382 Example:
5383 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5384
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005385http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005387 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5388 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5389 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005390
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005391
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005392http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005393 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5394
5395 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5396 no | yes | yes | yes
5397
5398 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5399 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5400 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5401 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5402 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5403 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5404
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005405 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5406 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005407
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005408 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005409
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005410 Example:
5411 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005412
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005413 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005414
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005415 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5416 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005417
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005418 Example:
5419 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005420
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005421 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005422
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005423 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5424 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005425
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005426 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5427 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005428
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005429http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005430
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005431 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5432 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5433 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5434 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5435 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5436 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5437 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5438 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005439
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005440http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005441
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005442 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5443 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5444 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5445 example, or to pass some internal information.
5446 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5447 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5448 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005449
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005450http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005451
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005452 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5453 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005454
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005455http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005456
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005457 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005458
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005459http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005460
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005461 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5462 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5463 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5464 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5465 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5466 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5467 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005468
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005469 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5470 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5471 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5472 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5473 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005474
5475 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5476 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5477 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5478 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005479
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005480http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005481
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005482 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5483 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5484 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5485 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5486 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5487 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005488
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005489http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005490
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005491 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005492
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005493http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005494
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005495 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5496 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5497 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5498 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5499 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5500 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005501
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005502http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5503 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005504
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005505 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005506 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5507 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005508 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5509 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5510 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5511 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5512 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005513 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005514
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005515http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005516
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005517 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5518 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5519 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5520 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5521 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5522 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005523
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005524http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5525 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005526
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005527 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5528 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005529
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005530 Example:
5531 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005532
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005533 # applied to:
5534 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005535
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005536 # outputs:
5537 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005538
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005539 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005540
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005541http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5542 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005543
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005544 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005545 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005546
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005547 Example:
5548 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005549
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005550 # applied to:
5551 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005552
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005553 # outputs:
5554 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005555
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005556http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5557 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5558 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005559 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005560 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5561
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005562 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005563 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5564 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5565 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5566 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005567 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005568 are followed to create the response :
5569
5570 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5571 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5572 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5573 ignored.
5574
5575 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5576 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5577 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5578 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5579 ignored.
5580
5581 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5582 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5583 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5584 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5585 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5586
5587 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5588 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5589 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5590 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5591 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5592 if any, is ignored.
5593
5594 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5595 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5596 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5597 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5598 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5599 as a raw content.
5600
5601 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5602 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5603 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5604 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5605 considered as a raw string.
5606
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005607 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5608 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5609 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5610 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5611
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005612 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5613 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5614 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5615
5616 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5617
5618 Example:
5619 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5620 if { status eq 404 }
5621
5622 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5623 string "This is the end !" \
5624 if { status eq 500 }
5625
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005626http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5627http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005628
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005629 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5630 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5631 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005632
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005633http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5634 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005635
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005636 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5637 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5638 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5639 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005640
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005641http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005642
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005643 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5644 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5645 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5646 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5647 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005648
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005649 Arguments:
5650 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005651
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005652 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5653 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005654
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005655http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005656
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005657 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5658 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5659 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005660
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005661http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5662
5663 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5664 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5665 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5666 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5667 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5668
5669http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5670
5671 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5672 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5673 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5674 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5675 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5676 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5677 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5678 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5679 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5680
5681http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5682
5683 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5684 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5685 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5686 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5687 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5688 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5689 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5690
5691http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5692
5693 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5694 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5695 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5696 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5697 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5698 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5699 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5700 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5701
5702http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5703 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5704
5705 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5706 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5707 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5708 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005709
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005710 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005711 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5712 http-response set-status 431
5713 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5714 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005715
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005716http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005717
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005718 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5719 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5720 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5721 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5722 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5723 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5724 based on some information from the request.
5725
5726 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5727
5728http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5729
5730 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5731 inline.
5732
5733 Arguments:
5734 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5735 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5736 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5737 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5738 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5739 (request and response)
5740 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5741 processing
5742 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5743 processing
5744 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5745 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5746 and '_'.
5747
5748 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5749 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005750
5751 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005752 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005754http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005755
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005756 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5757 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5758 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5759 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5760 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5761 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5762 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5763 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5764 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5765 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5766 action.
5767 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5768 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5769 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5770 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5771 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005772
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005773http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5774
5775 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5776 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5777 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5778 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5779 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005780 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005781 processing.
5782
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005783 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005784 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5785 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5786 rules evaluation.
5787
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005788http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5789http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5790http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005791
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005792 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5793 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5794 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5795 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5796 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5797 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5798
5799http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5800
5801 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5802 about <var-name>.
5803
5804 Example:
5805 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5806
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005807
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005808http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5809 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5810
5811 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5812 yes | no | yes | yes
5813
5814 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005815 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5816 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5817 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005818
5819 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5820
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005821 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5822 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5823 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5824 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5825 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5826 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5827 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5828 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5829 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5830 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005831
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005832 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5833 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5834 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5835 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5836 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5837 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5838 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5839 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005840
5841 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5842 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5843 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5844 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5845 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5846 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5847 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5848 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005849 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005850 downsides of rare connection failures.
5851
5852 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5853 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5854 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5855 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5856 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5857 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005858 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005859 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5860 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5861 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5862 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5863 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5864
5865 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005866 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5867 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5868 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005869
5870 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005871 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005872
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005873 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5874 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005875
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005876 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005877
5878 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5879 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5880 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5881
5882 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5883
5884
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005885http-send-name-header [<header>]
5886 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5888 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005889 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005890 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5891
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005892 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5893 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5894 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5895 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5896 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5897 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5898 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5899 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5900 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5901 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5902 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5903 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5904 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5905 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5906 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5907 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005908
5909 See also : "server"
5910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005911id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005912 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5914 no | yes | yes | yes
5915 Arguments : none
5916
5917 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5918 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5919 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005920
5921
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005922ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5923 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5924 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005925 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005926
5927 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5928 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5929 and running).
5930
5931 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5932 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5933 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005934 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005935 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5936
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005937 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5938 "unless" condition is met.
5939
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005940 Example:
5941 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5942 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5943 ignore-persist if url_static
5944
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005945 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5946
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005947load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5948 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5950 yes | no | yes | yes
5951
5952 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5953 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5954 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005955 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005956 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5957 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5958 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5959 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5960
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005961 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005962 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005963 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005964
5965 Arguments:
5966 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5967 named "server-state-file".
5968
5969 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5970 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5971 name is used as a file name.
5972
5973 none don't load any stat for this backend
5974
5975 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005976 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5977 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5978 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005979 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005980 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005981
5982 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5983 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5984
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005985 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005986
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005987 global
5988 stats socket /tmp/socket
5989 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005990
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005991 defaults
5992 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005993
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005994 backend bk
5995 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5996 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005997
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005998
5999 Then one can run :
6000
6001 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6002
6003 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6004
6005 1
6006 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6007 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6008 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6009
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006010 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006011
6012 global
6013 stats socket /tmp/socket
6014 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6015
6016 defaults
6017 load-server-state-from-file local
6018
6019 backend bk
6020 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6021 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6022
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006023
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006024 Then one can run :
6025
6026 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6027
6028 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6029
6030 1
6031 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6032 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6033 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6034
6035 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6036 "show servers state"
6037
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006038
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006039log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006040log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6041 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006042no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006043 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6045 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006046
6047 Prefix :
6048 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6049 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6050 prefix does not allow arguments.
6051
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006052 Arguments :
6053 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6054 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6055 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6056 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6057 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6058 parameter.
6059
6060 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6061 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6062
6063 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6064 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6065 standard syslog port).
6066
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006067 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6068 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6069 standard syslog port).
6070
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006071 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6072 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6073 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006074 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006075
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006076 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6077 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6078 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6079 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6080 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6081 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6082 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6083 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6084 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6085 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6086 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6087 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6088 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6089 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6090 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6091 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006092 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6093 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006094
6095 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6096 and "fd@2", see above.
6097
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006098 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6099 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6100 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6101 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6102 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6103 having the logs instantly available.
6104
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006105 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6106 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006107
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006108 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6109 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6110 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6111 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6112 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6113 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6114 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6115 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6116 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6117 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006118 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006119
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006120 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6121 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6122 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6123 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6124 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6125
6126 <sample_size>
6127 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6128 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6129 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6130 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6131 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6132
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006133 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6134 one of the following :
6135
6136 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6137 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6138
6139 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6140 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6141
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006142 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6143 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6144 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6145 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6146 systemd logger consumes.
6147
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006148 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6149 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6150 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6151 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6152
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006153 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6154
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006155 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6156 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6157 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6158
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006159 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6160 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6161 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6162 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006163
6164 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6165 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6166 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006167 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6168 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6169 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6170 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6171 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006172
6173 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6174
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006175 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6176 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6177 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006178
6179 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6180 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6181 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6182 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6183
6184 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6185 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006186
6187 Example :
6188 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006189 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6190 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6191 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006192 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6193 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006194 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006195
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006196
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006197log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006198 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6199 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6200 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006201
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006202 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6203 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6204 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6205 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6206 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006207
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006208 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6209 "option httplog" directives.
6210
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006211log-format-sd <string>
6212 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6213 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6214 yes | yes | yes | no
6215
6216 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6217 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6218 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6219 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6220 which covers the log format string in depth.
6221
6222 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6223 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6224
6225 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6226 log format to "rfc5424".
6227
6228 Example :
6229 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6230
6231
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006232log-tag <string>
6233 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6234 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6235 yes | yes | yes | yes
6236
6237 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6238 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6239 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6240 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6241 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6242 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6243 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6244 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6245 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006246
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006247max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6248 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6249 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6250 yes | no | yes | yes
6251
6252 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6253 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6254 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6255 servers.
6256
6257 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6258 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6259 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6260 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6261 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006262 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006263 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6264 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6265 picking a different server.
6266
6267 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6268 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6269 even if they have to be queued.
6270
6271 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6272 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6273
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006274max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6275 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6276 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6277 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006278
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006279maxconn <conns>
6280 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6282 yes | yes | yes | no
6283 Arguments :
6284 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6285 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6286 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6287 closes.
6288
6289 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6290 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6291 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6292 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006293 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6294 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6295 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6296 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006297
6298 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6299 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6300 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6301
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006302 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6303 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006304
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006305 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6306
6307
6308mode { tcp|http|health }
6309 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6311 yes | yes | yes | yes
6312 Arguments :
6313 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6314 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6315 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6316 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6317
6318 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6319 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6320 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6321 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6322 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6323
6324 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006325 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6326 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6327 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6328 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6329 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6330 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6331 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006332
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006333 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6334 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6335 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006336
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006337 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006338 defaults http_instances
6339 mode http
6340
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006341 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006342
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006343
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006344monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006345 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6347 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006348 Arguments :
6349 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6350 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006351 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006352 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6353 backend and its backup.
6354
6355 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6356 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6357 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6358 servers in a list of backends.
6359
6360 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6361 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6362 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6363 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6364 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6365 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6366 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006367 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6368 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006369
6370 Example:
6371 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006372 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006373 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6374 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6375 monitor-uri /site_alive
6376 monitor fail if site_dead
6377
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006378 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006379
6380
6381monitor-net <source>
6382 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6384 yes | yes | yes | no
6385 Arguments :
6386 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6387 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6388 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6389 followed by a mask.
6390
6391 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6392 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006393 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006394 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6395
6396 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6397 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6398 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6399 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006400 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6401 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6402 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006403
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006404 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6405 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6406 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6407 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6408 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6409 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006410
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006411 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6412 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006413
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006414 Example :
6415 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6416 frontend www
6417 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6418
6419 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6420
6421
6422monitor-uri <uri>
6423 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6425 yes | yes | yes | no
6426 Arguments :
6427 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6428 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6429
6430 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6431 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6432 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6433 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6434 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6435 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6436 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6437 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6438
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006439 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006440 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6441 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6442 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6443 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6444 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6445 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006446
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006447 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6448 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6449 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6450 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6451
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006452 Example :
6453 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6454 frontend www
6455 mode http
6456 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6457
6458 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006460
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006461option abortonclose
6462no option abortonclose
6463 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6465 yes | no | yes | yes
6466 Arguments : none
6467
6468 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6469 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6470 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6471 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006472 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006473 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6474 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6475 encountered while delivering the response.
6476
6477 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6478 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6479 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6480 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6481 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6482 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006483 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006484 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006485 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006486 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6487 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6488 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6489
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006490 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6491 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006492 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6493 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6494 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6495 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6496 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6497 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006498 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006499
6500 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6501 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6502
6503 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6504
6505
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006506option accept-invalid-http-request
6507no option accept-invalid-http-request
6508 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6510 yes | yes | yes | no
6511 Arguments : none
6512
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006513 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006514 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006515 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006516 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6517 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6518 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6519 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6520 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006521 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6522 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6523 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6524 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006525 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006526 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006527 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6528 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6529 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006530
6531 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6532 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6533 been confirmed.
6534
6535 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6536 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006537 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6538 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006539 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6540
6541 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6542 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6543
6544 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6545 stats socket.
6546
6547
6548option accept-invalid-http-response
6549no option accept-invalid-http-response
6550 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6552 yes | no | yes | yes
6553 Arguments : none
6554
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006555 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006556 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006557 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006558 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6559 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6560 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6561 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6562 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006563 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6564 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6565 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006566
6567 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6568 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6569 been confirmed.
6570
6571 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6572 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6573 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6574 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6575
6576 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6577 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6578
6579 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6580 stats socket.
6581
6582
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006583option allbackups
6584no option allbackups
6585 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6587 yes | no | yes | yes
6588 Arguments : none
6589
6590 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6591 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6592 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6593 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6594 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6595 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6596 order between the backup servers anymore.
6597
6598 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6599 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6600
6601 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6602 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6603
6604
6605option checkcache
6606no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006607 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6609 yes | no | yes | yes
6610 Arguments : none
6611
6612 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6613 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006614 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006615 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6616 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006617 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006618
6619 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006620 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006621 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006622 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6623 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006624 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006625 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006626 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6627 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006628 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006629 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6630 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006631 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006632 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6633 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6634 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6635 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6636 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6637 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6638 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6639 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6640 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6641
6642 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006643 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6644 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6645 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6646 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006647
6648 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6649 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006650 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006651 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006652
6653 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6654 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6655
6656
6657option clitcpka
6658no option clitcpka
6659 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6661 yes | yes | yes | no
6662 Arguments : none
6663
6664 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6665 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006666 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006667 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6668
6669 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6670 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6671 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6672 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6673
6674 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6675 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6676 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6677 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6678 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6679
6680 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6681
6682 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6683 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6684 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6685
6686 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6687 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6688
6689 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6690
6691
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006692option contstats
6693 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6695 yes | yes | yes | no
6696 Arguments : none
6697
6698 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6699 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6700 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6701 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006702 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6703 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6704 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6705 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6706 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006707
6708
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006709option dontlog-normal
6710no option dontlog-normal
6711 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6713 yes | yes | yes | no
6714 Arguments : none
6715
6716 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6717 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6718 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6719 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6720 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6721 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6722 logged.
6723
6724 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6725 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6726 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006728 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006729 logging.
6730
6731
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006732option dontlognull
6733no option dontlognull
6734 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6736 yes | yes | yes | no
6737 Arguments : none
6738
6739 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6740 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6741 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6742 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6743 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6744 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006745 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6746 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6747 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006748
6749 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006750 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006751 would not be logged.
6752
6753 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6754 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6755
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006756 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6757 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006758
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006759
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006760option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006761 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6763 yes | yes | yes | yes
6764 Arguments :
6765 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6766 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006767 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006768 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006769
6770 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6771 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6772 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6773 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6774 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6775 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6776 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006777 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6778 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6779 possible that the client has already brought one.
6780
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006781 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006782 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006783 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006784 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006785 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006786 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006787
6788 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6789 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6790 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6791 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6792 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6793 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6794 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6795
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006796 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6797 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6798 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6799 are under the control of the end-user.
6800
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006801 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006802 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6803 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006804 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6805 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6806 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006807
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006808 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006809 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6810 frontend www
6811 mode http
6812 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6813
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006814 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6815 backend www
6816 mode http
6817 option forwardfor header X-Client
6818
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006819 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006820 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006821
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006822
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006823option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6824no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6825 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6827 yes | yes | yes | no
6828 Arguments : none
6829
6830 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6831 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6832 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6833 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6834 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6835 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6836 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6837
6838 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6839 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6840 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6841 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6842 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6843 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6844 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6845 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6846 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6847 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6848
6849 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6850
6851 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6852 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6853
6854 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6855 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6856
6857
6858option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6859no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6860 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6862 yes | no | yes | yes
6863 Arguments : none
6864
6865 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6866 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6867 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6868 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6869 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6870 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6871 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6872
6873 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6874 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6875 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6876 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6877 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6878 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6879 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6880 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6881 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6882 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6883
6884 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6885
6886 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6887 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6888
6889 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6890 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6891
6892
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006893option http-buffer-request
6894no option http-buffer-request
6895 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6897 yes | yes | yes | yes
6898 Arguments : none
6899
6900 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6901 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6902 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6903 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6904 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6905 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006906 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6907 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6908 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6909 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006910
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006911 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006912
6913
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006914option http-ignore-probes
6915no option http-ignore-probes
6916 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6918 yes | yes | yes | no
6919 Arguments : none
6920
6921 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6922 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6923 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6924 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6925 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6926 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6927 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6928 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6929 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006930 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6931 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006932 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6933
6934 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6935 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6936 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6937 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6938 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6939 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6940 are often the only way to detect them.
6941
6942 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6943 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6944
6945 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6946
6947
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006948option http-keep-alive
6949no option http-keep-alive
6950 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6952 yes | yes | yes | yes
6953 Arguments : none
6954
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006955 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6956 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006957 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6958 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006959 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6960 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6961 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006962
6963 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6964 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006965 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6966 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6967 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6968 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6969 situations where this option may be useful :
6970
6971 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006972 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006973
6974 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6975 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6976
6977 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6978 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6979 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6980 request.
6981
6982 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6983 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006984 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6985 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6986 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006987
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006988 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6989 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6990 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6991 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6992 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6993 not set.
6994
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006995 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6996 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6997 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006998
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006999 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007000 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007001 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007002
7003
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007004option http-no-delay
7005no option http-no-delay
7006 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7008 yes | yes | yes | yes
7009 Arguments : none
7010
7011 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7012 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7013 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7014 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7015 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7016 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7017 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7018 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7019 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7020 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7021 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7022 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7023 affected.
7024
7025 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7026 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7027 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7028 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7029 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7030 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7031 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7032 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7033 latency environments.
7034
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007035 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7036
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007037
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007038option http-pretend-keepalive
7039no option http-pretend-keepalive
7040 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007042 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007043 Arguments : none
7044
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007045 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007046 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7047 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7048 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7049 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7050 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7051 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7052 consider the response complete.
7053
7054 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7055 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7056 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7057 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007058 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007059 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7060
7061 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7062 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7063 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7064 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7065 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7066 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7067 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7068
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007069 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7070 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7071 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7072 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7073 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7074 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007075
7076 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7077 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7078
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007079 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007080 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007081
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007082
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007083option http-server-close
7084no option http-server-close
7085 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7087 yes | yes | yes | yes
7088 Arguments : none
7089
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007090 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7091 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7092 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7093 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007094 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7095 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7096 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7097 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7098 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7099 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7100 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7101 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7102 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7103 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7104 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007105
7106 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7107 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7108 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7109 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007110 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7111 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007112
7113 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7114 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007115 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7116 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7117 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007118
7119 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7120 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7121
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007122 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7123 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007124
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007125option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007126no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007127 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7129 yes | yes | yes | no
7130 Arguments : none
7131
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007132 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007133 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7134 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7135 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7136 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7137 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7138 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7139
7140 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7141 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007142 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7143 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7144 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007145
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007146 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7147 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7148 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7149 front of an existing proxy.
7150
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007151 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7152
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007153 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007154
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007155option httpchk
7156option httpchk <uri>
7157option httpchk <method> <uri>
7158option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
7159 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
7160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7161 yes | no | yes | yes
7162 Arguments :
7163 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7164 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7165 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7166 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7167 ones.
7168
7169 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7170 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7171 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7172
7173 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7174 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7175 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007176 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007177
7178 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7179 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7180 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7181 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7182 the lack of any response.
7183
7184 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
7185
7186 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
7187 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
7188 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
7189
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007190 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7191 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7192 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7193 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7194
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007195 Examples :
7196 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7197 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7198 backend https_relay
7199 mode tcp
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007200 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7201 http-check send hdr Host www
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007202 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
7203
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007204 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7205 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7206 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007207
7208
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007209option httpclose
7210no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007211 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7213 yes | yes | yes | yes
7214 Arguments : none
7215
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007216 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7217 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7218 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7219 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007220 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007221
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007222 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7223 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007224 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007225 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7226 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007227
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007228 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7229 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7230 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007231
7232 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7233 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007234 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7235 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7236 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007237
7238 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7239 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7240
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007241 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007242
7243
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007244option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007245 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007247 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007248 Arguments :
7249 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7250 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7251 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007252 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007253 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007254
7255 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7256 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7257 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7258 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7259 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7260 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7261 ports.
7262
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007263 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7264 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007265
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007266 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007268 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007269
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007270
7271option http_proxy
7272no option http_proxy
7273 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7275 yes | yes | yes | yes
7276 Arguments : none
7277
7278 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7279 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7280 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7281 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7282 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7283
7284 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7285 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007286 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7287 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007288
7289 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7290 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7291
7292 Example :
7293 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7294 backend direct_forward
7295 option httpclose
7296 option http_proxy
7297
7298 See also : "option httpclose"
7299
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007300
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007301option independent-streams
7302no option independent-streams
7303 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7305 yes | yes | yes | yes
7306 Arguments : none
7307
7308 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7309 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7310 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7311 receive data or not.
7312
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007313 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007314 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7315 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7316 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7317 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7318 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7319 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7320 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7321 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7322 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7323 socket buffers.
7324
7325 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7326 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7327 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7328 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7329 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7330
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007331 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007332
7333
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007334option ldap-check
7335 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7337 yes | no | yes | yes
7338 Arguments : none
7339
7340 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7341 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7342 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7343 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7344
7345 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7346 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7347
7348 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7349 configure it.
7350
7351 Example :
7352 option ldap-check
7353
7354 See also : "option httpchk"
7355
7356
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007357option external-check
7358 Use external processes for server health checks
7359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7360 yes | no | yes | yes
7361
7362 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7363 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7364 command".
7365
7366 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7367
7368 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7369
7370
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007371option log-health-checks
7372no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007373 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7375 yes | no | yes | yes
7376 Arguments : none
7377
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007378 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7379 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7380 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007381
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007382 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7383 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7384 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7385 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7386 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7387
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007388 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007389 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007390
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007391 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7392 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7393 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007394
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007395
7396option log-separate-errors
7397no option log-separate-errors
7398 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7400 yes | yes | yes | no
7401 Arguments : none
7402
7403 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7404 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7405 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7406 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7407 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7408 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7409 provides very important information.
7410
7411 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7412 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7413 error logs.
7414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007415 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007416 logging.
7417
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007418
7419option logasap
7420no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007421 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7423 yes | yes | yes | no
7424 Arguments : none
7425
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007426 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7427 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7428 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7429 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7430
7431 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7432 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7433 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7434 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7435 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7436 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7437 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7438 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7439 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7440 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7441 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007442
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007443 Examples :
7444 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7445 mode http
7446 option httplog
7447 option logasap
7448 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7449
7450 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7451 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7452 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7453 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007455 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007456 logging.
7457
7458
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007459option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007460 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7462 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007463 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007464 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7465 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007466 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007467
7468 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7469 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007470 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007471 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7472 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7473 in the MySQL table, like this :
7474
7475 USE mysql;
7476 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7477 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7478
7479 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007480 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007481 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7482 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7483 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7484 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7485 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7486 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7487 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7488
7489 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7490 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007491
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007492 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007493
7494 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7495 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7496 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7497 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007498 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7499 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007500
7501 See also: "option httpchk"
7502
7503
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007504option nolinger
7505no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007506 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007507 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7508 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007509 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007510
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007511 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007512 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7513 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7514 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7515 connections.
7516
7517 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7518 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7519 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7520 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7521 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7522 this too.
7523
7524 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7525 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7526 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7527
7528 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7529 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7530 for servers.
7531
7532 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7533 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7534
7535
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007536option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7537 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7539 yes | yes | yes | yes
7540 Arguments :
7541 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7542 matching <network>
7543 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7544 header name.
7545
7546 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7547 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7548 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7549 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7550 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7551 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7552 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7553 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7554 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7555 possible that the client has already brought one.
7556
7557 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7558 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7559 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7560 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7561 header and requires different one.
7562
7563 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7564 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7565 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7566 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7567 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7568 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7569 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7570
7571 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7572 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7573 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7574 both are defined.
7575
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007576 Examples :
7577 # Original Destination address
7578 frontend www
7579 mode http
7580 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7581
7582 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7583 backend www
7584 mode http
7585 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7586
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007587 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007588
7589
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007590option persist
7591no option persist
7592 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7593 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7594 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007595 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007596
7597 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7598 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7599 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7600 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7601 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7602 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7603 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7604 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7605 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7606 redirected to another valid server.
7607
7608 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7609 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7610
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007611 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007612
7613
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007614option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7615 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7617 yes | no | yes | yes
7618 Arguments :
7619 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7620 PostgreSQL server.
7621
7622 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7623 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7624 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7625 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7626
7627 See also: "option httpchk"
7628
7629
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007630option prefer-last-server
7631no option prefer-last-server
7632 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7633 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7634 yes | no | yes | yes
7635 Arguments : none
7636
7637 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7638 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7639 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7640 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7641 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7642 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7643 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7644 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7645 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007646 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7647 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007648 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7649 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7650 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007651 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7652 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7653 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007654
7655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7657
7658 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7659
7660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007661option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007662option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007663no option redispatch
7664 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7666 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007667 Arguments :
7668 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7669 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7670 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007671 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007672 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007673 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007674 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7675 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7676 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007678
7679 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7680 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7681 be able to access the service anymore.
7682
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007683 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7684 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007685
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02007686 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
7687 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
7688 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
7689 following order:
7690
7691 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
7692
7693 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
7694 list, or
7695
7696 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
7697
7698 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
7699 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
7700
7701 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
7702 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
7703 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
7704 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
7705
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007706 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007707 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7708 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007710 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7711 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7712
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007713 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007714
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007715
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007716option redis-check
7717 Use redis health checks for server testing
7718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7719 yes | no | yes | yes
7720 Arguments : none
7721
7722 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7723 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7724 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7725 find the "+PONG" response message.
7726
7727 Example :
7728 option redis-check
7729
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007730 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007731
7732
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007733option smtpchk
7734option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7735 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7737 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007738 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007739 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007740 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007741 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7742
7743 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7744 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7745 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7746
7747 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7748 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7749 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7750 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7751 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7752 dead server.
7753
7754 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7755 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007756 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007757 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7758
7759 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7760 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7761 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7762 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007763 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007764
7765 Example :
7766 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7767
7768 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007771option socket-stats
7772no option socket-stats
7773
7774 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7776 yes | yes | yes | no
7777
7778 Arguments : none
7779
7780
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007781option splice-auto
7782no option splice-auto
7783 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7785 yes | yes | yes | yes
7786 Arguments : none
7787
7788 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7789 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007790 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007791 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007792 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007793 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7794 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7795 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7796 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7797
7798 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7799 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7800 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7801 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7802 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7803 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7804 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7805 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7806 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7807 keyword.
7808
7809 Example :
7810 option splice-auto
7811
7812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7814
7815 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7816 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7817
7818
7819option splice-request
7820no option splice-request
7821 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7823 yes | yes | yes | yes
7824 Arguments : none
7825
7826 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007827 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007828 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7829 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7830 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7831 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7832
7833 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7834
7835 Example :
7836 option splice-request
7837
7838 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7839 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7840
7841 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7842 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7843
7844
7845option splice-response
7846no option splice-response
7847 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7849 yes | yes | yes | yes
7850 Arguments : none
7851
7852 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007853 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007854 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7855 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7856 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7857 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7858
7859 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7860
7861 Example :
7862 option splice-response
7863
7864 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7865 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7866
7867 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7868 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7869
7870
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007871option spop-check
7872 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7874 no | no | no | yes
7875 Arguments : none
7876
7877 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7878 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7879 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7880 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7881
7882 Example :
7883 option spop-check
7884
7885 See also : "option httpchk"
7886
7887
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007888option srvtcpka
7889no option srvtcpka
7890 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7892 yes | no | yes | yes
7893 Arguments : none
7894
7895 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7896 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007897 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007898 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7899
7900 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7901 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7902 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7903 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7904
7905 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7906 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7907 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7908 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7909 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7910
7911 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7912
7913 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7914 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7915 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7916
7917 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7918 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7919
7920 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7921
7922
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007923option ssl-hello-chk
7924 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7926 yes | no | yes | yes
7927 Arguments : none
7928
7929 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7930 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7931 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7932 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7933 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7934 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7935 hello message.
7936
7937 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7938 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7939 messages, which is appreciable.
7940
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007941 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7942 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7943 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007944
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007945 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7946
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007947
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007948option tcp-check
7949 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7951 yes | no | yes | yes
7952
7953 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7954 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7955
7956 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7957 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7958 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7959
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007960 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007961 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7962 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7963 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7964 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7965 only.
7966
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007967 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007968 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7969 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7970 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7971 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7972
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007973 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007974 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7975 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007976 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007977 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7978 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7979 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7980 the respective protocols.
7981 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007982 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007983
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007984 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7985 script.
7986
7987 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7988 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7989 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7990 The "comment" is of course optional.
7991
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01007992 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available
7993 to store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing
7994 those variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
7995
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007996
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007997 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007998 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007999 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008000 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008001
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008002 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008003 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008004 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008005
8006 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8007 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008008 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008009 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008010 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008011 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008012 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008013 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008014 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8015 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008016 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008017 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8018 tcp-check expect string +OK
8019
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008020 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008021 (send many headers before analyzing)
8022 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008023 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008024 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8025 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8026 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8027 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008028 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008029
8030
8031 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
8032
8033
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008034option tcp-smart-accept
8035no option tcp-smart-accept
8036 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8038 yes | yes | yes | no
8039 Arguments : none
8040
8041 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8042 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8043 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8044 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8045 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8046 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8047
8048 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8049 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8050 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8051 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8052
8053 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8054 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8055 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008056 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008057
8058 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8059 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8060 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8061
8062 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8063 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8064 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8065
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008066 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8067
8068
8069option tcp-smart-connect
8070no option tcp-smart-connect
8071 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8073 yes | no | yes | yes
8074 Arguments : none
8075
8076 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8077 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8078 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8079 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8080 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8081
8082 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8083 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8084 complex.
8085
8086 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8087 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8088 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8089
8090 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8091 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8092
8093 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8094
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008095
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008096option tcpka
8097 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8099 yes | yes | yes | yes
8100 Arguments : none
8101
8102 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8103 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008104 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008105 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8106
8107 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8108 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8109 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8110 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8111
8112 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8113 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8114 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8115 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8116 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8117
8118 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8119
8120 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8121 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8122 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8123 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8124 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8125 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8126 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8127 backends.
8128
8129 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8130
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008131
8132option tcplog
8133 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008135 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008136 Arguments : none
8137
8138 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8139 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8140 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8141 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8142 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8143 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8144 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8145 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8146
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008147 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008149 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008150
8151
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008152option transparent
8153no option transparent
8154 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008156 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008157 Arguments : none
8158
8159 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8160 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8161 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8162 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8163 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8164 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8165 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8166 appropriate server.
8167
8168 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8169 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8170
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008171 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008172 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008173
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008174
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008175external-check command <command>
8176 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8178 yes | no | yes | yes
8179
8180 Arguments :
8181 <command> is the external command to run
8182
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008183 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8184
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008185 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008186
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008187 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8188 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8189 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8190 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8191 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8192 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008193
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008194 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8195
8196 Environment variables :
8197 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8198 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8199
8200 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8201
8202 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8203
8204 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8205 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8206 for a UNIX socket).
8207
8208 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8209
8210 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8211
8212 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8213
8214 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8215
8216 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8217
8218 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8219 socket).
8220
8221 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8222 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8223
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008224 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8225
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008226 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8227 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8228 failed.
8229
8230 Example :
8231 external-check command /bin/true
8232
8233 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8234
8235
8236external-check path <path>
8237 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8239 yes | no | yes | yes
8240
8241 Arguments :
8242 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8243
8244 The default path is "".
8245
8246 Example :
8247 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8248
8249 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8250 "external-check command"
8251
8252
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008253persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008254persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008255 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8257 yes | no | yes | yes
8258 Arguments :
8259 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008260 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8261 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008262
8263 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8264 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008265 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008266 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8267 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8268 forwarded to this server.
8269
8270 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8271 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8272 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008273 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008274 a single "listen" section.
8275
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008276 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8277 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8278 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8279
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008280 Example :
8281 listen tse-farm
8282 bind :3389
8283 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8284 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8285 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8286 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8287 persist rdp-cookie
8288 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008289 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008290 balance rdp-cookie
8291 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8292 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8293
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008294 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8295 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008296
8297
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008298rate-limit sessions <rate>
8299 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8301 yes | yes | yes | no
8302 Arguments :
8303 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8304 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8305
8306 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8307 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8308 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8309 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8310 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8311 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8312
8313 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8314 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8315 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8316 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8317
8318 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8319 listen smtp
8320 mode tcp
8321 bind :25
8322 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008323 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008324
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008325 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8326 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8327 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008328
8329 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8330
8331
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008332redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8333redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8334redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008335 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8337 no | yes | yes | yes
8338
8339 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008340 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008341
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008342 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008343 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008344 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8345 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8346 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008347
8348 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8349 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8350 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8351 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8352 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008353 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8354 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8355 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8356 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008357
8358 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8359 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8360 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8361 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8362 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8363 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008364 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008365 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008366 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8367 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8368 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008369
8370 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008371 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8372 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8373 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008374 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008375 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8376 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8377 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8378 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008379
8380 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008381 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008382
8383 - "drop-query"
8384 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8385 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8386 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8387 with a location-type redirect.
8388
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008389 - "append-slash"
8390 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8391 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8392 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8393 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8394
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008395 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8396 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8397 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8398 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8399 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8400 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8401 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8402
8403 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8404 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8405 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8406 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8407 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8408 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8409 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008410
8411 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8412 acl clear dst_port 80
8413 acl secure dst_port 8080
8414 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008415 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008416 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008417 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8418
8419 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008420 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8421 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8422 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008423 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008424
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008425 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8426 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8427 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8428
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008429 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008430 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008431
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008432 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008433 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8434 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8435 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008437 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008438
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008439
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008440retries <value>
8441 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8442 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8443 yes | no | yes | yes
8444 Arguments :
8445 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8446 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8447 default value is 3.
8448
8449 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8450 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8451 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8452
8453 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008454 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8455 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008456
8457 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8458 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8459
8460 See also : "option redispatch"
8461
8462
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008463retry-on [list of keywords]
8464 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8465 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8466 yes | no | yes | yes
8467 Arguments :
8468 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8469 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8470 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8471 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8472
8473 none never retry
8474
8475 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8476 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8477
8478 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8479 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8480 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8481 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8482 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8483 processing the request.
8484
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008485 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8486 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8487 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8488 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8489 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8490 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8491 overflow attack for example).
8492
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008493 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8494 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8495 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8496 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8497 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8498 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8499 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8500 amplify denial of service attacks.
8501
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008502 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8503 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8504 considered to be safe to retry.
8505
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008506 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8507 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8508 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8509 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8510
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008511 all-retryable-errors
8512 retry request for any error that are considered
8513 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8514 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8515 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8516
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008517 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8518 not cumulative.
8519
8520 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8521 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8522 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8523 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8524
8525 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8526 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8527 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8528 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8529 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8530 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8531 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8532 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8533 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8534 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8535 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8536 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8537
8538 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8539 should not use this directive.
8540
8541 The default is "conn-failure".
8542
8543 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8544
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008545server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008546 Declare a server in a backend
8547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8548 no | no | yes | yes
8549 Arguments :
8550 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008551 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008552 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008553
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008554 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8555 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8556 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8557 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008558 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8559 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8560 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8561 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8562 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008563 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8564 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8565 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8566 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8567 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8568 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8569 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008570 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008571 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8572 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8573 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8574 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8575 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8576 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008577 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8578 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008579 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8580 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008581
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008582 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008583 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8584 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8585 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8586 adding this value to the client's port.
8587
8588 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8589 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008590 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008591
8592 Examples :
8593 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8594 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008595 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008596 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8597 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8598 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008599
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008600 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8601 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8602 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8603 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8604 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8605
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008606 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8607 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008608
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008609server-state-file-name [<file>]
8610 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8611 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8612 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8613 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8614 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8615 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8616
8617 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8618 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8619
8620 global
8621 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8622
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008623 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008624 load-server-state-from-file
8625
8626 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8627 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008628
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008629server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8630 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8631 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8633 no | no | yes | yes
8634
8635 Arguments:
8636 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8637
8638 <num | range>
8639 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8640 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8641 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8642 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8643
8644 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8645
8646 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8647
8648 <params*>
8649 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8650 keyword.
8651
8652 Examples:
8653 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8654 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8655 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8656
8657 # or
8658 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8659
8660 # would be equivalent to:
8661 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8662 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8663 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8664
8665
8666
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008667source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008668source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008669source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008670 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8672 yes | no | yes | yes
8673 Arguments :
8674 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8675 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008676
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008677 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008678 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8679 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8680 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8681 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8682 supported prefixes are :
8683 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8684 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8685 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008686 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008687 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8688 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008689
8690 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8691 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008692 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8693 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8694 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008695
8696 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8697 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8698 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8699 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8700 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8701 <addr>.
8702
8703 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8704 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8705 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8706 port.
8707
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008708 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8709 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8710 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8711 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008712 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008713 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8714 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8715 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8716 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8717 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8718 HTTP header.
8719
8720 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8721 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008722 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008723 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8724 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8725 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8726 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8727 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8728 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8729 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8730
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008731 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8732 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8733 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8734 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8735 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8736 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8737
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008738 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8739 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8740 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8741 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8742
8743 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8744 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8745 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8746 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8747 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8748 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8749
8750 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8751 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8752 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8753 there are two methods :
8754
8755 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8756 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8757 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8758 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8759 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8760 of the client ranges may be used.
8761
8762 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8763 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8764 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8765 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8766 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8767 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8768 same session.
8769
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008770 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8771 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8772 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008773 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008774
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008775 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8776
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008777 Examples :
8778 backend private
8779 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8780 source 192.168.1.200
8781
8782 backend transparent_ssl1
8783 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8784 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8785
8786 backend transparent_ssl2
8787 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8788 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8789 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8790
8791 backend transparent_ssl3
8792 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8793 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8794 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8795
8796 backend transparent_smtp
8797 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8798 # with Tproxy version 4.
8799 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8800
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008801 backend transparent_http
8802 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8803 # proxy.
8804 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008806 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008807 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8808
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008809
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008810stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8811 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008813 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008814
8815 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8816 matched.
8817
8818 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8819 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8820
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008821 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8822 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008823 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008824
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008825 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8826 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8827 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8828 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008829
8830 Example :
8831 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8832 backend stats_localhost
8833 stats enable
8834 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8835
8836 Example :
8837 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8838 backend stats_auth
8839 stats enable
8840 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8841 stats admin if TRUE
8842
8843 Example :
8844 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8845 userlist stats-auth
8846 group admin users admin
8847 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8848 group readonly users haproxy
8849 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8850
8851 backend stats_auth
8852 stats enable
8853 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8854 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8855 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8856 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8857
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008858 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8859 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8860 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008861
8862
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008863stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8864 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008866 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008867 Arguments :
8868 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8869
8870 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8871
8872 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8873 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8874 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8875 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8876 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8877 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8878
8879 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8880 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8881 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008882 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008883
8884 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8885 report using "stats scope".
8886
8887 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8888 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8889 unobvious parameters.
8890
8891 Example :
8892 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8893 backend public_www
8894 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8895 stats enable
8896 stats hide-version
8897 stats scope .
8898 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008899 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008900 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8901 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8902
8903 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8904 backend private_monitoring
8905 stats enable
8906 stats uri /admin?stats
8907 stats refresh 5s
8908
8909 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8910
8911
8912stats enable
8913 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008915 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008916 Arguments : none
8917
8918 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8919 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8920 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8921 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8922 - stats auth : no authentication
8923 - stats scope : no restriction
8924
8925 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8926 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8927 unobvious parameters.
8928
8929 Example :
8930 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8931 backend public_www
8932 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8933 stats enable
8934 stats hide-version
8935 stats scope .
8936 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008937 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008938 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8939 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8940
8941 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8942 backend private_monitoring
8943 stats enable
8944 stats uri /admin?stats
8945 stats refresh 5s
8946
8947 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8948
8949
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008950stats hide-version
8951 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008953 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008954 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008955
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008956 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8957 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8958 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8959 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8960 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8961 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008963 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8964 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8965 unobvious parameters.
8966
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008967 Example :
8968 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8969 backend public_www
8970 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008971 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008972 stats hide-version
8973 stats scope .
8974 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008975 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008976 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8977 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008978
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008979 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8980 backend private_monitoring
8981 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008982 stats uri /admin?stats
8983 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008984
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008985 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008986
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008987
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008988stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8989 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8990 Access control for statistics
8991
8992 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8993 no | no | yes | yes
8994
8995 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8996 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8997 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8998 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8999 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9000 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9001
9002 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9003 instance.
9004
9005 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9006 about ACL usage.
9007
9008
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009009stats realm <realm>
9010 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009012 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009013 Arguments :
9014 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9015 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9016 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9017
9018 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9019 using a backslash ('\').
9020
9021 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9022 only related to authentication.
9023
9024 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9025 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9026 unobvious parameters.
9027
9028 Example :
9029 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9030 backend public_www
9031 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9032 stats enable
9033 stats hide-version
9034 stats scope .
9035 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009036 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009037 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9038 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9039
9040 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9041 backend private_monitoring
9042 stats enable
9043 stats uri /admin?stats
9044 stats refresh 5s
9045
9046 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9047
9048
9049stats refresh <delay>
9050 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009052 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009053 Arguments :
9054 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9055 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9056 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9057 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9058 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9059 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9060
9061 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9062 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9063 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9064 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9065
9066 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9067 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9068 unobvious parameters.
9069
9070 Example :
9071 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9072 backend public_www
9073 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9074 stats enable
9075 stats hide-version
9076 stats scope .
9077 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009078 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009079 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9080 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9081
9082 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9083 backend private_monitoring
9084 stats enable
9085 stats uri /admin?stats
9086 stats refresh 5s
9087
9088 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9089
9090
9091stats scope { <name> | "." }
9092 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009094 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009095 Arguments :
9096 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9097 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9098 section in which the statement appears.
9099
9100 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9101 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9102 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9103 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9104 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9105 exists.
9106
9107 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9108 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9109 unobvious parameters.
9110
9111 Example :
9112 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9113 backend public_www
9114 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9115 stats enable
9116 stats hide-version
9117 stats scope .
9118 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009119 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009120 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9121 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9122
9123 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9124 backend private_monitoring
9125 stats enable
9126 stats uri /admin?stats
9127 stats refresh 5s
9128
9129 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9130
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009131
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009132stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009133 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009135 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009136
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009137 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009138 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9139
9140 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9141 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9142
9143 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9144 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009145 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009146
9147 Example :
9148 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9149 backend private_monitoring
9150 stats enable
9151 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9152 stats uri /admin?stats
9153 stats refresh 5s
9154
9155 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9156 global section.
9157
9158
9159stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009160 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9162 yes | yes | yes | yes
9163 Arguments : none
9164
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009165 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009166 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9167 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9168 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9169 - IP (socket, server)
9170 - cookie (backend, server)
9171
9172 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9173 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009174 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009175
9176 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9177
9178
9179stats show-node [ <name> ]
9180 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009182 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009183 Arguments:
9184 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9185 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9186
9187 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9188 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009189 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009190
9191 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9192 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9193 unobvious parameters.
9194
9195 Example:
9196 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9197 backend private_monitoring
9198 stats enable
9199 stats show-node Europe-1
9200 stats uri /admin?stats
9201 stats refresh 5s
9202
9203 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9204 section.
9205
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009206
9207stats uri <prefix>
9208 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009210 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009211 Arguments :
9212 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9213 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9214 query string.
9215
9216 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9217 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9218 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9219 possible to reach it in the application.
9220
9221 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009222 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009223 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9224 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9225 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9226 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9227
9228 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9229 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9230 an address or a port to statistics only.
9231
9232 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9233 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9234 unobvious parameters.
9235
9236 Example :
9237 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9238 backend public_www
9239 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9240 stats enable
9241 stats hide-version
9242 stats scope .
9243 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009244 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009245 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9246 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9247
9248 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9249 backend private_monitoring
9250 stats enable
9251 stats uri /admin?stats
9252 stats refresh 5s
9253
9254 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9255
9256
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009257stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9258 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009260 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009261
9262 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009263 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009264 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009265 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009266 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9267
9268 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9269 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9270 the "stick-table" statement.
9271
9272 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9273 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9274 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9275 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9276 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9277
9278 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9279 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9280 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9281 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9282 transformation rules.
9283
9284 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9285 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9286 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9287 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9288 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9289 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9290 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9291
9292 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9293 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9294 ACL based conditions.
9295
9296 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9297 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9298 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9299 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9300
9301 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9302 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9303 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9304 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9305
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009306 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9307 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009308 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009309
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009310 Example :
9311 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9312 # last 30 minutes
9313 backend pop
9314 mode tcp
9315 balance roundrobin
9316 stick store-request src
9317 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9318 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9319 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9320
9321 backend smtp
9322 mode tcp
9323 balance roundrobin
9324 stick match src table pop
9325 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9326 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9327
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009328 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009329 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009330
9331
9332stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9333 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9335 no | no | yes | yes
9336
9337 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9338 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9339 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9340 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9341
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009342 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9343 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009344 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009345
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009346 Examples :
9347 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009348 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009349
9350 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9351 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9352 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9353
9354
9355 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9356 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9357 backend http
9358 mode http
9359 balance roundrobin
9360 stick on src table https
9361 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9362 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9363 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9364
9365 backend https
9366 mode tcp
9367 balance roundrobin
9368 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9369 stick on src
9370 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9371 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9372
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009373 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009374
9375
9376stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9377 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9379 no | no | yes | yes
9380
9381 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009382 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009383 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009384 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009385 server is selected.
9386
9387 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9388 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9389 the "stick-table" statement.
9390
9391 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9392 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9393 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9394 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9395 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9396 address.
9397
9398 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9399 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9400 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9401 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9402 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9403 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9404 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9405 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9406 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9407 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9408
9409 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9410 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9411 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9412 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9413 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9414 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9415 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9416
9417 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9418 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9419 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9420 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9421
9422 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9423 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9424 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9425 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9426 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9427 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009428 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9429 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9430 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9431 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9432 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9433 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009434
9435 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9436 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9437 the request.
9438
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009439 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9440 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009441 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009442
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009443 Example :
9444 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9445 # last 30 minutes
9446 backend pop
9447 mode tcp
9448 balance roundrobin
9449 stick store-request src
9450 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9451 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9452 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9453
9454 backend smtp
9455 mode tcp
9456 balance roundrobin
9457 stick match src table pop
9458 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9459 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9460
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009461 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009462 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009463
9464
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009465stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009466 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9467 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009468 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009470 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009471
9472 Arguments :
9473 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9474 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9475 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9476 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9477
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009478 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9479 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9480 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9481 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9482
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009483 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9484 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9485 instance.
9486
9487 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9488 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9489 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9490 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9491 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9492 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009493 to 32 characters.
9494
9495 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9496 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9497 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009498 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009499 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9500 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009501
9502 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009503 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9504 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009505 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9506 increase.
9507
9508 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009509 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9510 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9511 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009512
9513 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9514 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9515 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9516 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009517 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009518 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9519 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9520 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9521 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9522 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9523 parameter (see below).
9524
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009525 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9526 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9527 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9528 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9529 soft restart.
9530
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009531 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9532 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009533
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009534 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9535 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9536 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9537 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009538 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009539 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009540 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9541 if not expiration delay is specified.
9542
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009543 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9544 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9545 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9546 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009547 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9548 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9549 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9550 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9551 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9552 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9553 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9554 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9555 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9556 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9557 types and their arguments.
9558
9559 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9560 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9561 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9562 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9563
9564 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9565 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9566 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009567 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009568
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009569 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9570 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9571 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009572 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009573 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009574 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009575
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009576 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9577 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9578 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9579 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9580
9581 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9582 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9583 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9584 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9585 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9586 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9587
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009588 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9589 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9590 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9591 they were received.
9592
9593 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9594 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9595 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9596 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9597 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9598
9599 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9600 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9601 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9602 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9603 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9604
9605 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9606 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9607 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9608
9609 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9610 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9611 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9612 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9613 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9614
9615 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9616 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9617 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9618 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9619 the client side.
9620
9621 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9622 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9623 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9624 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9625 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9626 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9627 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9628
9629 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9630 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9631 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9632 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9633 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9634 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009635 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009636
9637 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9638 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9639 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9640 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9641 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9642 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9643
9644 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009645 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009646 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9647 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9648
9649 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9650 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9651 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9652 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9653 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9654 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9655 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9656 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9657 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9658 recommended for better fairness.
9659
9660 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009661 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009662 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9663 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9664
9665 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9666 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9667 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9668 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9669 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9670 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9671 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9672 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9673 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9674 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009675
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009676 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9677 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009678 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9679 reference it.
9680
9681 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9682 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009683 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9684 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9685 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009686
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009687 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9688 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9689 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9690 something that can be ignored.
9691
9692 Example:
9693 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9694 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9695 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9696 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9697
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009698 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009699 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009700
9701
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009702stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009703 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9705 no | no | yes | yes
9706
9707 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009708 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009709 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009710 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009711 server is selected.
9712
9713 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9714 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9715 the "stick-table" statement.
9716
9717 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9718 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9719 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9720 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9721
9722 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9723 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9724 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9725 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9726 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9727 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009728 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009729 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9730 rules.
9731
9732 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9733 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9734 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9735 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9736 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9737 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9738 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9739
9740 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9741 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9742 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9743 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9744
9745 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9746 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9747 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9748 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9749 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9750 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009751 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9752 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9753 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9754 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9755 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9756 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9757 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9758 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9759 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009760
9761 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9762
9763 Example :
9764 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9765 backend https
9766 mode tcp
9767 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009768 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009769 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009770
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009771 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9772 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9773
9774 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9775 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9776 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9777
9778 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9779 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009780
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009781 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9782 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9783 # at offset 44.
9784
9785 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9786 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9787
9788 # Learn on response if server hello.
9789 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009790
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009791 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9792 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9793
9794 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9795 extraction.
9796
9797
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009798tcp-check connect [params*]
9799 Opens a new connection
9800 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9801 no | no | yes | yes
9802
9803 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9804 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9805 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9806
9807 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9808 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9809 of the sequence.
9810
9811 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9812 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9813 do.
9814
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009815 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
9816 unset-var or comment rules.
9817
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009818 Parameters :
9819 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9820 use the TCP connection.
9821
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +02009822 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
9823 checks. This parameter is exclusive with all other options.
9824
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +02009825 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +02009826 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9827 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +02009828 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +02009829
9830 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009831
9832 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9833
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +02009834 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
9835
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009836 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9837
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +02009838 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
9839
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +02009840 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
9841 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
9842 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9843 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
9844
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +02009845 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009846
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009847 Examples:
9848 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9849 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9850 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9851 option tcp-check
9852 tcp-check connect
9853 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9854 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9855 tcp-check send \r\n
9856 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9857 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9858 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9859 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9860 tcp-check send \r\n
9861 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9862 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9863
9864 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9865 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009866 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009867 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9868 tcp-check connect port 143
9869 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9870 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9871
9872 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9873
9874
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +02009875tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +02009876 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +02009877 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009878 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9880 no | no | yes | yes
9881
9882 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009883 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
9884 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
9885 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
9886 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
9887 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
9888 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
9889 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
9890 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
9891 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
9892 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
9893
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009894 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009895 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
9896 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009897 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9898 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9899 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9900
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +02009901 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
9902 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
9903 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported and
9904 may be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7RSP,
9905 HCHK_STATUS_L7STS, HCHK_STATUS_L6RSP or HCHK_STATUS_L4CON
9906 error status. By default "L7RSP" is used.
9907
9908 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
9909 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
9910 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported and may
9911 be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7TOUT,
9912 HCHK_STATUS_L6TOUT or HCHK_STATUS_L4TOUT timeout status.
9913 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
9914
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +02009915 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
9916 informational message reported in logs if the expect
9917 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
9918 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
9919
9920 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
9921 informational message reported in logs if an error
9922 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
9923 log-format string.
9924
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +02009925 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
9926 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
9927 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9928 followed by some converters.
9929
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009930 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9931 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9932 with the usual backslash ('\').
9933 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009934 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009935 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9936 used upper or lower case.
9937
9938
9939 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9940
9941 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9942 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9943 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9944 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9945 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9946 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9947 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9948 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9949
9950 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9951 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9952 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9953 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9954 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9955 expression.
9956
9957 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9958 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9959 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9960 this exact hexadecimal string.
9961 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9962
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009963 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
9964 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
9965 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
9966 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
9967 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
9968 size of the original response. As such, the expected
9969 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
9970 size.
9971
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009972 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9973 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9974 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9975 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9976 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9977 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9978 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9979 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9980 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9981 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9982 the null character.
9983
9984 Examples :
9985 # perform a POP check
9986 option tcp-check
9987 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9988
9989 # perform an IMAP check
9990 option tcp-check
9991 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9992
9993 # look for the redis master server
9994 option tcp-check
9995 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009996 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009997 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9998 tcp-check expect string role:master
9999 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10000 tcp-check expect string +OK
10001
10002
10003 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10004 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10005
10006
10007tcp-check send <data>
10008 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10009 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10010 no | no | yes | yes
10011
10012 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10013 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
10014
10015 Examples :
10016 # look for the redis master server
10017 option tcp-check
10018 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10019 tcp-check expect string role:master
10020
10021 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10022 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10023
10024
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010025tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
10026 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010027 tcp health check
10028 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10029 no | no | yes | yes
10030
10031 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10032 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010033 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010034 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
10035 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
10036 hexadecimal string.
10037 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
10038
10039 Examples :
10040 # redis check in binary
10041 option tcp-check
10042 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10043 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10044
10045
10046 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10047 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10048
10049
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010050tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10051
10052 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
10053
10054 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10055 no | no | yes | yes
10056
10057 Arguments:
10058 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10059 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10060 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10061 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10062 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10063 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10064 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10065 and '-'.
10066
10067 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10068
10069 Example:
10070 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10071
10072
10073tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
10074
10075 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
10076
10077 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10078 no | no | yes | yes
10079
10080 Arguments:
10081 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10082 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10083 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10084 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10085 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10086 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10087 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10088 and '-'.
10089
10090 Example:
10091 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10092
10093
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010094tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10095 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10097 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010098 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010099 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10100 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010101
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010102 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010103
10104 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10105 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010106 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10107 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10108 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10109 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10110 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10111 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010112
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010113 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10114 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10115 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10116 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010117
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010118 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010119 - accept :
10120 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10121 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10122 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010123
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010124 - reject :
10125 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10126 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10127 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10128 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10129 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10130 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10131 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10132 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10133 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10134 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10135 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010136 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010137
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010138 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10139 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10140 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10141 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10142 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10143 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10144 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10145 hosts.
10146
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010147 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10148 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10149 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10150 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10151 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10152 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10153 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10154 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10155
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010156 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10157 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10158 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10159 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10160 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10161 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10162 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10163 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10164 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010165 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10166 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010167
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010168 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010169 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010170 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10171 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10172 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010173 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010174 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10175 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10176 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10177 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10178 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10179 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10180 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10181 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010182
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010183 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010184 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010185 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010186 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010187 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10188 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10189 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010190
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010191 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10192 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10193 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10194 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010195
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010196 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10197 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10198 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10199 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10200 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010201 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10202 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10203 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10204 layer7 information is extracted.
10205
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010206 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10207 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10208 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10209 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10210 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010211
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010212 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10213 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10214 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10215 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10216
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010217 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10218 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10219 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10220 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10221
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010222 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10223 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10224 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10225 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10226 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010227
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010228 - set-src <expr> :
10229 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10230 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10231 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010232 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010233
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010234 Arguments:
10235 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10236 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010237
10238 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010239 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10240
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010241 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10242 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010243
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010244 - set-src-port <expr> :
10245 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10246 expression.
10247
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010248 Arguments:
10249 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10250 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010251
10252 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010253 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10254
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010255 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10256 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10257 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010258
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010259 - set-dst <expr> :
10260 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10261 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10262 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10263 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10264 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10265
10266 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10267 followed by some converters.
10268
10269 Example:
10270
10271 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10272 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10273
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010274 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10275 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10276
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010277 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10278 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10279 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10280 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10281
10282
10283 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10284 followed by some converters.
10285
10286 Example:
10287
10288 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10289
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010290 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10291 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10292 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10293
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010294 - "silent-drop" :
10295 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010296 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010297 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10298 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10299 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10300 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10301 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010302 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10303 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010304 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10305 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010306 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010307 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10308 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10309 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10310 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10311
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010312 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10313 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10314 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010315
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010316 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10317 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10318 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010319
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010320 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010321 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010322 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010323
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010324 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10325 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10326 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010327
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010328 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010329 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10330 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010331
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010332 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10333
10334 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10335
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010336 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10337
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010338 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010339
10340
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010341tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10342 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010344 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010345 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010346 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10347 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010348
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010349 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010350
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010351 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010352 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10353 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10354 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10355 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010356
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010357 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10358 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10359 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10360 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010361 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10362 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10363 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10364 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10365 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10366 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010367 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010368 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010369
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010370 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10371 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10372 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10373 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010374
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010375 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010376 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010377 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010378 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10379 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010380 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010381 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010382 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010383 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010384 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010385 - set-dst <expr>
10386 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010387 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010388 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010389 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010390 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010391 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010392
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010393 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10394 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010395 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10396 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010397
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010398 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10399 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10400 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10401 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10402 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10403 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010404
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010405 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010406 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10407 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010408
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010409 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010410 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10411 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10412 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10413 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010414 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10415 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10416 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010417
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010418 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010419 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10420 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10421 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010422
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010423 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10424 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10425
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010426 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010427 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10428 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010429
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010430 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10431 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010432 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010433 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10434 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010435 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010436 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010437 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010438 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10439 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010440 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010441 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10442 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010443
10444 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10445 followed by some converters.
10446
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010447 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10448 <var-name>.
10449
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010450 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10451 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10452 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10453 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10454 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10455
10456 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10457 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10458 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10459 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10460 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10461 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10462 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10463 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10464 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10465 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10466 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10467
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010468 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10469 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10470 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10471 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10472 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10473
10474 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10475
10476 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10477
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010478 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10479 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10480 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10481 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10482 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10483 evaluated.
10484
10485 Example:
10486 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10487
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010488 Example:
10489
10490 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010491 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010492
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010493 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010494 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10495 # and reject everything else.
10496 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10497 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010498 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010499 tcp-request content reject
10500
10501 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010502 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10503 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10504 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010505 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010506
10507 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10508 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10509 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010510 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010511 tcp-request content reject
10512
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010513 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010514 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010515 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010516 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010517 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10518 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010519
10520 Example:
10521 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10522 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010523 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010524
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010525 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010526 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010527
10528 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010529 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010530 # protecting all our sites
10531 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010532 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10533 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010534 ...
10535 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10536
10537 backend http_dynamic
10538 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010539 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010540 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010541 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010542 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010543 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010544 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010546 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010547
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010548 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10549 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010550
10551
10552tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10553 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010555 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010556 Arguments :
10557 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10558 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10559 as explained at the top of this document.
10560
10561 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10562 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10563 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10564 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10565 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10566
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010567 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10568 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10569 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10570 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10571
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010572 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10573 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010574 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010575 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010576 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10577 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10578 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10579 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010580
10581 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10582 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10583 it pass through unaffected.
10584
10585 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10586 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10587 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010588 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010589 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10590 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010591 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10592 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10593 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010594
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010595 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010596 "timeout client".
10597
10598
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010599tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10600 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10602 no | no | yes | yes
10603 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010604 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10605 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010606
10607 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10608
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010609 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010610 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10611 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010612 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10613 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010614
10615 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10616
10617 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10618 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10619 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10620 inserted.
10621
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010622 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010623 - accept :
10624 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10625 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10626 the rules evaluation.
10627
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010628 - close :
10629 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10630 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10631 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10632 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10633 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10634 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010635 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010636 protocols.
10637
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010638 - reject :
10639 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10640 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010641 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010642
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010643 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10644 Sets a variable.
10645
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010646 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10647 Unsets a variable.
10648
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010649 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10650 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10651 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10652 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10653
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010654 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10655 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10656 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10657 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10658
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010659 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10660 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10661 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10662 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10663 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010664
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010665 - "silent-drop" :
10666 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010667 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010668 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10669 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10670 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10671 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10672 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010673 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10674 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010675 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10676 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010677 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010678 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10679 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10680 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10681 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10682
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010683 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10684 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10685
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010686 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10687 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10688 for changing the default action to a reject.
10689
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010690 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10691 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10692 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10693 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010694 period.
10695
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010696 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10697 declared inline.
10698
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010699 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10700 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010701 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010702 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10703 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010704 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010705 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010706 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010707 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10708 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010709 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010710 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10711 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010712
10713 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10714 followed by some converters.
10715
10716 Example:
10717
10718 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10719
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010720 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10721 <var-name>.
10722
10723 Example:
10724
10725 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10726
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010727 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10728 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10729 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10730 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10731 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10732
10733 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10734
10735 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10736
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010737 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10738
10739 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10740
10741
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010742tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10743 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10745 no | yes | yes | no
10746 Arguments :
10747 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10748 below.
10749
10750 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10751
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010752 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010753 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10754 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10755 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10756 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10757 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10758 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10759 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010760 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010761 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10762 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10763 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10764 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10765 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10766 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10767 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10768 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10769 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10770 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10771 instead.
10772
10773 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10774 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10775 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10776 rules which may be inserted.
10777
10778 Several types of actions are supported :
10779 - accept : the request is accepted
10780 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10781 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10782 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010783 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010784 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010785 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010786 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010787 - silent-drop
10788
10789 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10790 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10791 sections for a complete description.
10792
10793 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10794 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10795 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10796
10797 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10798 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10799 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10800 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10801 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10802
10803 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10804 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10805
10806 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10807 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10808 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10809
10810 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10811 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10812 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10813
10814 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10815 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10816 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10817
10818 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10819 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10820 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10821
10822 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10823
10824 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10825
10826
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010827tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10828 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10830 no | no | yes | yes
10831 Arguments :
10832 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10833 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10834 as explained at the top of this document.
10835
10836 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10837
10838
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010839timeout check <timeout>
10840 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10841 established.
10842
10843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10844 yes | no | yes | yes
10845 Arguments:
10846 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10847 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10848 as explained at the top of this document.
10849
10850 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10851 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010852 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010853 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010854 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10855 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10856 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010857
10858 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10859 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10860
10861 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10862 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010863 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010864
10865 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10866 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10867 forget about it.
10868
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010869 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10870 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010871
10872
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010873timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010874 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10876 yes | yes | yes | no
10877 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010878 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010879 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10880 as explained at the top of this document.
10881
10882 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10883 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10884 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010885 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10886 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10887 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10888 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010889 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10890 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10891 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010892 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010893 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010894 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10895 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010896 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10897 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010898
10899 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10900 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10901 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10902 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010903 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010904 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10905
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010906 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010907
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010908 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010909
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010910
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010911timeout client-fin <timeout>
10912 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10914 yes | yes | yes | no
10915 Arguments :
10916 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10917 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10918 as explained at the top of this document.
10919
10920 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10921 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10922 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10923 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10924 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10925 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10926 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010927 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10928 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10929 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010930
10931 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10932 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10933 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10934
10935 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10936
10937
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010938timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010939 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10941 yes | no | yes | yes
10942 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010943 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010944 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10945 as explained at the top of this document.
10946
10947 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010948 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010949 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010950 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010951 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10952 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010953
10954 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10955 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10956 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10957 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010958 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010959 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10960
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010961 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010962
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010963
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010964timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10965 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10967 yes | yes | yes | yes
10968 Arguments :
10969 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10970 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10971 as explained at the top of this document.
10972
10973 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10974 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10975 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10976 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10977 once the request has started to present itself.
10978
10979 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10980 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10981 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10982 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10983 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10984
10985 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10986 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10987 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10988 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10989
10990 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10991 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010992 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010993 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10994 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010995 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010996
10997 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10998 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10999 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11000 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11001
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011002 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11003 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011004 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11005
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011006 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11007
11008
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011009timeout http-request <timeout>
11010 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011012 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011013 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011014 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011015 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11016 as explained at the top of this document.
11017
11018 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11019 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11020 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11021 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11022 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11023 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11024 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011025 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11026 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11027 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11028 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011029 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011030 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11031 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011032
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011033 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11034 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11035 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11036 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11037 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011038 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011039
11040 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11041 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011042 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011043 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11044 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11045
11046 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011047 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11048 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11049 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011050
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011051 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011052 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011053
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011054
11055timeout queue <timeout>
11056 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11058 yes | no | yes | yes
11059 Arguments :
11060 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11061 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11062 as explained at the top of this document.
11063
11064 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11065 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11066 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11067 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11068 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11069
11070 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11071 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11072 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11073 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11074
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011075 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011076
11077
11078timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011079 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11081 yes | no | yes | yes
11082 Arguments :
11083 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11084 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11085 as explained at the top of this document.
11086
11087 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11088 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11089 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11090 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11091 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11092 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11093 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11094
11095 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11096 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11097 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11098 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11099 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011100 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011101 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011102 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11103 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011104 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11105 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011106
11107 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11108 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11109 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11110 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011111 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011112 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11113
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011114 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011115
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011116
11117timeout server-fin <timeout>
11118 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11120 yes | no | yes | yes
11121 Arguments :
11122 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11123 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11124 as explained at the top of this document.
11125
11126 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11127 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11128 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11129 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11130 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11131 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11132 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11133 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11134 situations, it should not be needed.
11135
11136 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11137 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11138 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11139
11140 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11141
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011142
11143timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011144 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11146 yes | yes | yes | yes
11147 Arguments :
11148 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11149 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11150 as explained at the top of this document.
11151
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011152 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11153 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11154 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011155
11156 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11157 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11158 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11159 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011160 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011161
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011162 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011163
11164
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011165timeout tunnel <timeout>
11166 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11168 yes | no | yes | yes
11169 Arguments :
11170 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11171 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11172 as explained at the top of this document.
11173
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011174 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011175 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11176 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11177 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011178 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11179 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011180 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11181 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11182 specified.
11183
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011184 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11185 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11186 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11187 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11188 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11189 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11190 state.
11191
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011192 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11193 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11194 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11195 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011196 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011197
11198 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11199 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11200 forget about it.
11201
11202 Example :
11203 defaults http
11204 option http-server-close
11205 timeout connect 5s
11206 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011207 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011208 timeout server 30s
11209 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11210
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011211 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011212
11213
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011214transparent (deprecated)
11215 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011217 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011218 Arguments : none
11219
11220 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11221 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11222 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11223 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11224 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11225 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11226 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11227 appropriate server.
11228
11229 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11230
11231 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11232 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11233
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011234 See also: "option transparent"
11235
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011236unique-id-format <string>
11237 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11239 yes | yes | yes | no
11240 Arguments :
11241 <string> is a log-format string.
11242
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011243 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11244 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11245 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11246 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011247
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011248 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11249 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11250 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11251 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11252 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11253 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11254 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11255 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011256
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011257 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11258 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011259
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011260 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011261
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011262 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011263
11264 will generate:
11265
11266 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11267
11268 See also: "unique-id-header"
11269
11270unique-id-header <name>
11271 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11273 yes | yes | yes | no
11274 Arguments :
11275 <name> is the name of the header.
11276
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011277 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11278 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011279
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011280 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011281
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011282 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011283 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11284
11285 will generate:
11286
11287 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11288
11289 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011290
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011291use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011292 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11294 no | yes | yes | no
11295 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011296 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11297 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011298
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011299 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11300 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011301
11302 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11303 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11304 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011305 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011306 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011307 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11308 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011309
11310 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11311 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11312 assign the backend.
11313
11314 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11315 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11316 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11317 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11318 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11319 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11320
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011321 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011322 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011323 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11324 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11325 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11326
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011327 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11328 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11329 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11330 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11331 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11332 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11333 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11334 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11335 cannot be forced from the request.
11336
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011337 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011338 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11339 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11340
11341 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11342 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011343
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011344use-fcgi-app <name>
11345 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11347 no | no | yes | yes
11348 Arguments :
11349 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11350
11351 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011352
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011353use-server <server> if <condition>
11354use-server <server> unless <condition>
11355 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11357 no | no | yes | yes
11358 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011359 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11360 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011361
11362 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11363
11364 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11365 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11366 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11367
11368 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11369 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11370 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11371 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11372 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11373 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11374 matches will assign the server.
11375
11376 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11377 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11378 with the next rules until one matches.
11379
11380 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11381 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11382 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11383 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11384
11385 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11386 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11387 stripped.
11388
11389 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11390 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11391 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11392 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11393
11394 Example :
11395 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11396 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11397 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11398 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11399 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11400 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011401 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011402 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11403 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11404
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011405 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11406 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11407 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11408 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11409 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11410 and we fall back to load balancing.
11411
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011412 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011413
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011414
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100114155. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011416--------------------------
11417
11418The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11419depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11420settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11421written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11422described in this section.
11423
11424
114255.1. Bind options
11426-----------------
11427
11428The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11429as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11430no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11431parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11432while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11433provided immediately after the setting name.
11434
11435The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11436
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011437accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11438 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11439 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11440 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11441 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11442 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11443 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11444 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11445 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11446 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011447 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11448 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11449 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011450
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011451accept-proxy
11452 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011453 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11454 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011455 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11456 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11457 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11458 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011459 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011460 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11461 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011462 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11463 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011464
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011465allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011466 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011467 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011468 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011469 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11470 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011471
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011472alpn <protocols>
11473 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11474 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11475 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011476 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011477 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011478 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11479 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11480 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11481 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11482 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11483 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11484 preference, like below :
11485
11486 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011487
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011488backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011489 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011490 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11491
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011492curves <curves>
11493 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11494 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11495 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11496 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11497 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11498 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11499
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011500ecdhe <named curve>
11501 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011502 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11503 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011504
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011505ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11507 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11508 client's certificate.
11509
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011510ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11511 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11512 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11513 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11514 error is ignored.
11515
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011516ca-sign-file <cafile>
11517 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11518 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11519 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11520 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11521 'generate-certificates' for details.
11522
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011523ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011524 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11525 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11526 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11527 'generate-certificates' for details.
11528
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011529ca-verify-file <cafile>
11530 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
11531 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
11532 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
11533 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
11534 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
11535
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011536ciphers <ciphers>
11537 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11538 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011539 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011540 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011541 information and recommendations see e.g.
11542 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11543 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11544 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11545
11546ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11547 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11548 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11549 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11550 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011551 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11552 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011553
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011554crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011555 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11556 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11557 to verify client's certificate.
11558
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011559crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011560 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11561 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11562 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11563 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11564 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011565 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11566 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011567
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010011568 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
11569 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
11570
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011571 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11572 are loaded.
11573
11574 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010011575 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
11576 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
11577 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
11578 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
11579 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
11580 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
11581 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011582 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011583
11584 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11585 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11586 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11587 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011588 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11589 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011590
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011591 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011592
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011593 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011594 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011595 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11596 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011597 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11598 clients).
11599
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011600 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11601 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11602 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11603 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11604 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11605 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11606 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11607 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11608 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11609 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11610 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11611 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11612 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11613
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011614 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11615 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11616 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11617 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11618 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11619
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011620 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11621 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11622 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11623 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011624
11625 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11626 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11627 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11628 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11629 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11630 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11631 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11632 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11633 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11634
11635 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11636
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011637 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011638 a cert bundle.
11639
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011640 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011641 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11642 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11643 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11644 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11645 provide multi-cert support.
11646
11647 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11648
11649 Filename | CN | SAN
11650 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11651 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011652 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011653 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11654 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11655
11656 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11657 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11658 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11659 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011660 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11661 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11662 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011663
11664 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11665 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11666
11667 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11668 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11669 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11670
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011671crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011672 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011673 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011674 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011675 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011676
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011677crt-list <file>
11678 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011679 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11680 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011681
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011682 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11683
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011684 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
11685 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
11686 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
11687 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011688
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011689 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11690 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11691 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11692 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11693 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11694 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11695 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11696 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011697
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011698 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011699 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011700 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11701 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11702 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011703
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011704 crt-list file example:
11705 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011706 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011707 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011708 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011709
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011710defer-accept
11711 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11712 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11713 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011714 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011715 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11716 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11717 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11718 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11719 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11720 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11721 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11722
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011723expose-fd listeners
11724 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11725 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011726 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11727 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011728 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011729
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011730force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011731 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011732 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011733 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011734 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011735
11736force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011737 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011738 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011739 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011740
11741force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011742 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011743 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011744 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011745
11746force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011747 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011748 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011749 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011750
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011751force-tlsv13
11752 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11753 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011754 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011755
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011756generate-certificates
11757 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11758 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11759 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11760 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11761 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11762 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11763 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11764 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11765 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11766 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11767 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11768
11769 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11770 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011771 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011772 certificate is used many times.
11773
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011774gid <gid>
11775 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11776 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11777 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11778 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11779 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11780
11781group <group>
11782 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11783 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11784 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11785 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11786 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11787
11788id <id>
11789 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11790 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11791 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11792 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11793
11794interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011795 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11796 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11797 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11798 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11799 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11800 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011801 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11802 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11803 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11804 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11805 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11806 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011807
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011808level <level>
11809 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11810 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11811 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011812 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011813 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11814 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11815 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011816 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011817 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011818 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011819 all counters).
11820
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011821severity-output <format>
11822 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11823 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11824 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11825 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11826 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11827 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11828 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11829 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11830 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11831 rfc5424 convention.
11832
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011833maxconn <maxconn>
11834 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11835 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11836 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11837 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11838 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11839 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11840 eat all memory.
11841
11842mode <mode>
11843 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11844 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11845 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11846 UNIX sockets.
11847
11848mss <maxseg>
11849 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11850 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11851 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11852 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11853 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11854 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11855 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11856 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11857 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11858 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11859 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11860
11861name <name>
11862 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11863 page.
11864
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011865namespace <name>
11866 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11867 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11868 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11869 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11870
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011871nice <nice>
11872 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11873 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11874 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11875 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11876 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11877 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11878 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11879 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11880 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11881 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11882 one for an RDP socket.
11883
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011884no-ca-names
11885 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11886 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011887 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011888
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011889no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011890 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011891 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011892 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011893 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011894 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11895 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011896
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011897no-tls-tickets
11898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11899 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11900 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011901 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11902 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011903 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11904 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11905 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011906
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011907no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011908 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011909 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011910 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011911 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011912 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11913 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011914
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011915no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011917 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011918 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011919 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011920 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11921 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011922
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011923no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011924 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011925 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011926 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011927 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011928 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11929 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011930
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011931no-tlsv13
11932 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11933 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11934 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11935 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011936 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11937 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011938
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011939npn <protocols>
11940 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11941 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11942 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011943 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011944 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011945 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11946 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11947 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11948 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11949 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011950
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011951prefer-client-ciphers
11952 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11953 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11954 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011955 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11956 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11957 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011958
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011959process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011960 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011961 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011962 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011963 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11964 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11965 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11966 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011967 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011968 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11969 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11970 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11971 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11972 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011973
11974 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11975
11976 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11977 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11978 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11979 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11980 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11981 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11982 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11983 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011984
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011985proto <name>
11986 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11987 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11988 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11989 in haproxy -vv.
11990 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11991 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011992 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011993 h2" on the bind line.
11994
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011995ssl
11996 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011997 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011998 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11999 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012000 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12001 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012002
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012003ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12004 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
12005 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12006 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12007
12008ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12009 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
12010 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12011 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12012
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012013strict-sni
12014 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12015 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12016 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12017 See the "crt" option for more information.
12018
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012019tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012020 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012021 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12022 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012023 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012024 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12025 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12026 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12027 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12028 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12029 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12030 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12031
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012032tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012033 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012034 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12035 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12036 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12037 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12038 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12039 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12040 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012041 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12042 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12043 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012044
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012045tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12046 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012047 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12048 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12049 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12050 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12051 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12052 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12053 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12054 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12055 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12056 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012057 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12058 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12059
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012060transparent
12061 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12062 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12063 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12064 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12065 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12066 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12067 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12068 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12069 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12070 so check for support with your vendor.
12071
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012072v4v6
12073 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12074 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12075 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12076 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012077 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012078
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012079v6only
12080 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12081 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12082 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012083 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12084 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012085
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012086uid <uid>
12087 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12088 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12089 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12090 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12091 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12092
12093user <user>
12094 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12095 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12096 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12097 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12098 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12099
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012100verify [none|optional|required]
12101 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12102 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12103 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12104 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12105 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012106 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12107 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12108 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12109 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012110
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200121115.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012112------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012114The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12115which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12116arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12117settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12118after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12119Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12120address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012122 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012123 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012124
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012125Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12126keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012128The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012129
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012130addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012131 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012132 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12133 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12134 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12135 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12136 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012137
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012138agent-check
12139 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012140 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012141 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12142 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12143 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012144
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012145 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012146 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012147 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12148 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12149 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012150
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012151 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12152 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12153 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12154 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12155 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012156
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012157 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012158 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012159
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012160 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12161 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12162 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012163
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012164 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12165 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12166 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012167
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012168 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12169 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12170 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12171 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12172 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012173 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012174 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012175
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012176 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12177 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012178
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012179 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12180 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12181 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12182 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12183 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12184 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12185 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12186 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12187 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012188
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012189 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12190 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012191 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12192 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12193 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012194 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012195
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012196 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012197 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012198
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012199agent-send <string>
12200 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12201 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12202 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12203 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12204 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12205
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012206agent-inter <delay>
12207 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12208 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12209
12210 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12211 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12212 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12213 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12214 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12215 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12216 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12217 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12218 of backends use the same servers.
12219
12220 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12221
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012222agent-addr <addr>
12223 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12224
12225 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12226 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12227 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12228 hostname, it will be resolved.
12229
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012230agent-port <port>
12231 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12232
12233 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12234
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012235allow-0rtt
12236 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012237 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12238 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012239
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012240alpn <protocols>
12241 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12242 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12243 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012244 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012245 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12246 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12247 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12248 now obsolete NPN extension.
12249 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12250 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12251
12252 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12253
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012254backup
12255 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12256 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12257 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12258 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012259 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12260 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012261
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012262ca-file <cafile>
12263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12264 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12265 server's certificate.
12266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012267check
12268 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012269 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12270 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12271 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12272 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12273 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12274 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12275 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012276 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12277 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012278 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12279 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012280
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012281check-send-proxy
12282 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12283 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12284 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12285 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12286 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12287 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12288 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12289
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012290check-alpn <protocols>
12291 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12292 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12293 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12294
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012295check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012296 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012297 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12298 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012299
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012300check-ssl
12301 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12302 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12303 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12304 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012305 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012306 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12307 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012308 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012309 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12310 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012311
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012312check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012313 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012314 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12315 for normal traffic.
12316
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012317ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12319 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12320 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012321 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12322 information and recommendations see e.g.
12323 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12324 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12325 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012326
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012327ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12328 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12329 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12330 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12331 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012332 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12333 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12334 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012335
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012336cookie <value>
12337 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12338 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12339 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12340 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12341 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12342 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12343 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12344
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012345crl-file <crlfile>
12346 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12347 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12348 to verify server's certificate.
12349
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012350crt <cert>
12351 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12352 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12353 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12354 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12355 certificate request.
12356
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012357disabled
12358 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12359 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12360 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12361 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12362 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012363 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012364
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012365enabled
12366 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12367 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12368 default value.
12369 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12370 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012371
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012372error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012373 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12374 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12375 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012377 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012378
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012379fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012380 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12381 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12382 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12383
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012384force-sslv3
12385 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12386 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012387 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012388 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012389
12390force-tlsv10
12391 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012392 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012393 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012394
12395force-tlsv11
12396 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012397 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012398 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012399
12400force-tlsv12
12401 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012402 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012403 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012404
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012405force-tlsv13
12406 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12407 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012408 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012410id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012411 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12412 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12413 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012414
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012415init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12416 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12417 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012418 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012419 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12420 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12421 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12422 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12423 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12424 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12425 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12426 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12427 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012428 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012429 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12430 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12431 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12432 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12433 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12434 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012435 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012436
12437 Example:
12438 defaults
12439 # never fail on address resolution
12440 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12441
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012442inter <delay>
12443fastinter <delay>
12444downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012445 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12446 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12447 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12448 between checks depending on the server state :
12449
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012450 Server state | Interval used
12451 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12452 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12453 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12454 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12455 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12456 or yet unchecked. |
12457 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12458 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12459 | "inter" otherwise.
12460 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012462 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12463 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12464 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12465 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012466 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12467 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12468 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12469 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12470 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012471
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012472maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012473 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12474 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012475 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12476 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012477 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12478 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12479 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12480 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12481
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012482 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12483 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12484 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12485 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12486 than 50 concurrent requests.
12487
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012488maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012489 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12490 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12491 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12492 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12493 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12494 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12495 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12496
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012497max-reuse <count>
12498 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12499 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12500 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12501 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12502 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12503 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12504 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12505 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12506
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012507minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012508 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12509 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12510 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12511 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12512 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12513 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012514 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012515 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012516
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012517namespace <name>
12518 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12519 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12520 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12521 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12522
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012523no-agent-check
12524 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12525 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12526 default value.
12527 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12528 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12529
12530no-backup
12531 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12532 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12533 default value.
12534 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12535 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12536
12537no-check
12538 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12539 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12540 default value.
12541 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12542 "default-server" "check" setting.
12543
12544no-check-ssl
12545 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12546 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12547 default value.
12548 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12549 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12550
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012551no-send-proxy
12552 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12553 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12554 default value.
12555 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12556 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12557
12558no-send-proxy-v2
12559 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12560 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12561 default value.
12562 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12563 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12564
12565no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12566 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12567 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12568 default value.
12569 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12570 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12571
12572no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12573 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12574 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12575 default value.
12576 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12577 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12578
12579no-ssl
12580 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12581 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12582 default value.
12583 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12584 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12585
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012586no-ssl-reuse
12587 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12588 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12589 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12590 and for paranoid users.
12591
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012592no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012593 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12594 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012595 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012596
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012597 Supported in default-server: No
12598
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012599no-tls-tickets
12600 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12601 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12602 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012603 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12604 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012605 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12606 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12607 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012608 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012609
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012610no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012611 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012612 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12613 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012614 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12615 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012616 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012617
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012618 Supported in default-server: No
12619
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012620no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012621 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012622 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12623 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012624 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12625 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012626 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012627
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012628 Supported in default-server: No
12629
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012630no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012631 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012632 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12633 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012634 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12635 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012636 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012637
12638 Supported in default-server: No
12639
12640no-tlsv13
12641 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12642 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12643 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12644 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12645 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012646 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012647
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012648 Supported in default-server: No
12649
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012650no-verifyhost
12651 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12652 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12653 default value.
12654 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12655 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012656
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012657no-tfo
12658 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12659 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12660 default value.
12661 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12662 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12663
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012664non-stick
12665 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12666 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12667 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12668
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012669npn <protocols>
12670 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12671 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12672 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012673 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012674 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12675 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12676 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012678observe <mode>
12679 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12680 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12681 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12682 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12683 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12684 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012685 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012686
12687 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12688
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012689on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012690 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12691 Currently, four modes are available:
12692 - fastinter: force fastinter
12693 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12694 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12695 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12696 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12697
12698 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12699
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012700on-marked-down <action>
12701 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12702 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012703 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12704 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12705 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12706 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12707 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12708 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12709 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12710 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012711
12712 Actions are disabled by default
12713
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012714on-marked-up <action>
12715 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12716 Currently one action is available:
12717 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12718 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12719 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12720 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012721 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12722 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012723 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12724 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12725
12726 Actions are disabled by default
12727
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012728pool-max-conn <max>
12729 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12730 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12731 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12732 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12733 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12734 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12735
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012736pool-purge-delay <delay>
12737 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012738 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012739 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012741port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012742 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12743 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12744 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12745 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12746 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12747 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12748
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012749proto <name>
12750
12751 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12752 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12753 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12754 reported in haproxy -vv.
12755 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12756 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012758redir <prefix>
12759 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12760 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12761 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12762 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12763 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12764 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12765 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12766 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012767 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012768 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012769 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12770 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12771 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12772 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12773
12774 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12775
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012776rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012777 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12778 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12779 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12780
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012781resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12782 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12783 server.
12784
12785 Available options:
12786
12787 * allow-dup-ip
12788 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12789 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12790 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12791 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12792 For such case, simply enable this option.
12793 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12794
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012795 * ignore-weight
12796 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12797 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12798 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12799
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012800 * prevent-dup-ip
12801 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12802 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12803 same fqdn.
12804 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12805
12806 Example:
12807 backend b_myapp
12808 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12809 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12810 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12811
12812 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12813 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12814 it
12815 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12816 different address
12817
12818 Default value: not set
12819
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012820resolve-prefer <family>
12821 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12822 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12823 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12824 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12825
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012826 Default value: ipv6
12827
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012828 Example:
12829
12830 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012831
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012832resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012833 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012834 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012835 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012836 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12837 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012838 configured network, another address is selected.
12839
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012840 Example:
12841
12842 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012843
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012844resolvers <id>
12845 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12846 hostname.
12847
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012848 Example:
12849
12850 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012851
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012852 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012853
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012854send-proxy
12855 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12856 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12857 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12858 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012859 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12860 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12861 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12862 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12863 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12864 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12865 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12866 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12867 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12868 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012869 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12870 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012871
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012872send-proxy-v2
12873 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12874 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12875 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12876 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012877 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12878 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12879 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12880 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012881
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012882proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010012883 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
12884 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
12885
12886 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
12887 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
12888 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
12889 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
12890 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
12891 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
12892 connection is supported).
12893 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
12894 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
12895 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
12896 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
12897 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
12898 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
12899 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012900
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012901send-proxy-v2-ssl
12902 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12903 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12904 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12905 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12906 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12907 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12908 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012909 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12910 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012911
12912send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12913 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12914 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12915 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12916 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12917 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12918 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12919 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12920 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012921 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12922 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012924slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012925 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12926 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12927 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12928 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12929 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12930 parameters :
12931
12932 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12933 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12934
12935 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12936 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12937 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12938 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12939
12940 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12941 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12942 seen as failed.
12943
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012944sni <expression>
12945 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12946 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12947 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12948 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012949 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12950 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012951 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012952 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12953 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012954
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012955source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012956source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012957source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012958 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12959 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12960 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12961 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12962
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012963 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12964 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12965 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12966 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12967 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12968 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12969 server.
12970
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012971 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12972 specifying the source address without port(s).
12973
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012974ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012975 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12976 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12977 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12978 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12979 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12980 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012981 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12982 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012983
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012984ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12985 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12986 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12987 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12988
12989ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12990 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12991 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12992 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12993
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012994ssl-reuse
12995 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12996 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12997 default value.
12998 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12999 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13000
13001stick
13002 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13003 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13004 default value.
13005 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13006 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013007
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013008socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013009 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013010 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13011 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13012
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013013tcp-ut <delay>
13014 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13015 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13016 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013017 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013018 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13019 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13020 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13021 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13022 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13023 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13024 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13025 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13026 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13027
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013028tfo
13029 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13030 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13031 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13032 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13033 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013034 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013036track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013037 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13038 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13039 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13040 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013041 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13042
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013043tls-tickets
13044 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13045 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13046 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013047 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13048 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13049 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013050 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013051 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013052
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013053verify [none|required]
13054 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013055 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013056 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13057 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013058 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013059 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13060 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13061 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13062 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13063 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13064 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13065 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13066 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013067
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013068verifyhost <hostname>
13069 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013070 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13071 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13072 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13073 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13074 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13075 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13076 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13077 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013078
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013079weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013080 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13081 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13082 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013083 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13084 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13085 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13086 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13087 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13088 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013089
13090
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130915.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13092-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013093
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013094HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13095using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13096configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013097This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13098can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13099workload.
13100This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13101resolution at run time.
13102Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13103carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13104
13105
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200131065.3.1. Global overview
13107----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013108
13109As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13110different steps of the process life:
13111
13112 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13113 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13114 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13115
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013116 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13117 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013118
13119A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13120 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13121 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13122 resolution to know this new IP.
13123
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013124When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013125HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013126SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13127from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13128will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13129will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013130
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013131A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013132 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013133 first valid response.
13134
13135 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13136 servers return an error.
13137
13138
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200131395.3.2. The resolvers section
13140----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013141
13142This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013143HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13144contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013145
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013146When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13147uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13148is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13149answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13150
13151When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013152used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013153
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013154 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13155 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13156 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013157
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013158 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13159 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013160
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013161 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13162 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13163 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013164
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013165For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13166following scenarios are possible:
13167
13168 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13169 ignored
13170
13171 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13172 applied
13173
13174 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13175 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13176
13177 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13178 retries the query with a new type
13179
13180 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13181 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013182
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013183As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13184a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013185<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013186
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013187
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013188resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013189 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013190
13191A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13192
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013193accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013194 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013195 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013196 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13197 by RFC 6891)
13198
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013199 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13200
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013201nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13202 DNS server description:
13203 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13204 <ip> : IP address of the server
13205 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13206
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013207parse-resolv-conf
13208 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13209 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13210 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13211
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013212hold <status> <period>
13213 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13214 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013215 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013216 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013217 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13218 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13219 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13220
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013221 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013222
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013223resolve_retries <nb>
13224 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13225 giving up.
13226 Default value: 3
13227
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013228 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13229 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13230 type.
13231
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013232timeout <event> <time>
13233 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13234 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13235 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013236 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13237 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013238 Default value: 1s
13239 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013240 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013241 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013242 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13243 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13244
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013245 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013246
13247 resolvers mydns
13248 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13249 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013250 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013251 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013252 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013253 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013254 hold other 30s
13255 hold refused 30s
13256 hold nx 30s
13257 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013258 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013259 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013260
13261
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200132626. Cache
13263---------
13264
13265HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13266(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13267RAM.
13268
13269The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13270this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13271
13272If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13273independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13274when we try to allocate a new one.
13275
13276The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13277
13278It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13279"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13280for more details.
13281
13282When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13283replaced by "<CACHE>".
13284
13285
132866.1. Limitation
13287----------------
13288
13289The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13290
13291- If the response is not a 200
13292- If the response contains a Vary header
13293- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13294- If the response is not cacheable
13295
13296- If the request is not a GET
13297- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13298- If the request contains an Authorization header
13299
13300
133016.2. Setup
13302-----------
13303
13304To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13305the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13306
13307
133086.2.1. Cache section
13309---------------------
13310
13311cache <name>
13312 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13313 size of cache is mandatory.
13314
13315total-max-size <megabytes>
13316 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13317 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13318
13319max-object-size <bytes>
13320 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13321 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13322 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13323
13324max-age <seconds>
13325 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13326 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13327 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13328 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13329 default.
13330
13331
133326.2.2. Proxy section
13333---------------------
13334
13335http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13336 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13337 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13338 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13339 after this one.
13340
13341http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13342 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13343 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13344 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13345 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13346
13347
13348Example:
13349
13350 backend bck1
13351 mode http
13352
13353 http-request cache-use foobar
13354 http-response cache-store foobar
13355 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13356
13357 cache foobar
13358 total-max-size 4
13359 max-age 240
13360
13361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13363----------------------------------
13364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013365HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013366client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13367The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13368these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13369but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13370data called patterns.
13371
13372
133737.1. ACL basics
13374---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013375
13376The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13377content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13378from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13379simple :
13380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013381 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013382 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013383 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13384 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013386The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13387adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013388
13389In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013391 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013392
13393This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13394Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13395and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013396an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13397conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13398as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13399are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013400
13401ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13402'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13403which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13404
13405There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13406performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013408The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13409specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13410this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013411methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13412ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013413
13414Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13415 - boolean
13416 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13417 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13418 - string
13419 - data block
13420
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013421Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13422converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13423would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13424The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13425which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13426
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013427Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13428keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13429fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13430which are summarized in the table below :
13431
13432 +---------------------+-----------------+
13433 | Sample or converter | Default |
13434 | output type | matching method |
13435 +---------------------+-----------------+
13436 | boolean | bool |
13437 +---------------------+-----------------+
13438 | integer | int |
13439 +---------------------+-----------------+
13440 | ip | ip |
13441 +---------------------+-----------------+
13442 | string | str |
13443 +---------------------+-----------------+
13444 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13445 +---------------------+-----------------+
13446
13447Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13448matching method, see below.
13449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013450The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13451 - boolean
13452 - integer or integer range
13453 - IP address / network
13454 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13455 - regular expression
13456 - hex block
13457
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013458The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13459
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013460 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13461 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013462 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013463 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013464 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013465 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013466 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013468The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13469read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13470if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13471lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13472will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13473beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13474a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13475lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13476exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13477
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013478The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13479parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13480ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13481a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13482check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13483
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013484The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13485socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13486file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013488Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13489loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13490
13491 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13492
13493In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13494the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13495case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13496as well.
13497
13498The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13499sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13500do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13501methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13502is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013503obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013504followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13505default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13506that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13507string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13508
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013509The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13510By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13511string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13512resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13513server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013514waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013515flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13516function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013518There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13519sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13520be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013521
13522 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13523 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013524 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13525 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13526 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13527 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013528
13529 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13530 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013531 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013532
13533 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013534 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013535
13536 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013537 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013538
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013539 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013540 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13541
13542 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13543 binary or string samples.
13544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013545 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13546 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013548 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13549 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13550 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013552 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13553 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013555 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13556 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013558 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13559 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013561 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13562 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013563 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013565 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13566 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13567 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013568
13569For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13570request, it is possible to do :
13571
13572 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13573
13574In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13575buffer, one would use the following acl :
13576
13577 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13578
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013579On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13580possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13581
13582 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013584All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13585criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13586method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13587to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13588criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13589the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013591If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013592the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13593For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013595 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13596 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13597 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13598 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013599
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013600
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013601The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13602types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13603combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13604brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13605default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013607 +-------------------------------------------------+
13608 | Input sample type |
13609 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013610 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013611 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13612 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13613 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013614 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013615 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013616 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013617 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013618 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013619 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013620 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013621 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013622 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013623 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013624 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013625 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013626 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013627 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013628 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013629 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013630 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013631 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013632 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013633 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013634 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013635 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13636 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13637 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013638
13639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136407.1.1. Matching booleans
13641------------------------
13642
13643In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13644Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13645When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13646that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13647
13648Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13649return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13650"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13651
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136537.1.2. Matching integers
13654------------------------
13655
13656Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13657enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13658to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13659
13660Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13661matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13662lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013663
13664For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13665unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13666representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13667
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013668As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13669two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13670instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13671ranges and operators.
13672
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013673For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013674operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13675Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13676of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013677
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013678Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013679
13680 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13681 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13682 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13683 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13684 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013686For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013687
13688 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13689
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013690This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13691
13692 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13693
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136957.1.3. Matching strings
13696-----------------------
13697
13698String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13699different forms :
13700
13701 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013702 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013703
13704 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013705 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013706
13707 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13708 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13709
13710 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13711 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13712
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013713 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013714 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13715 matches.
13716
13717 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13718 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13719 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013720
13721String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13722exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13723characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13724string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13725to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013726before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013727
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013728Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13729(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13730Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13731
13732Example:
13733 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13734 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13735
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200137377.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13738---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013739
13740Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13741they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13742possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13743passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13744the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013745the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13746match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013747
13748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200137497.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13750-------------------------------------
13751
13752It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13753not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13754a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13755to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13756digits may be used upper or lower case.
13757
13758Example :
13759 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13760 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13761
13762
137637.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13764---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013765
13766IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13767netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13768within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013769host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013770difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13771at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13772does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13773parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013774
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013775The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13776abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13777
13778 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13779 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13780 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13781 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13782 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13783 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13784 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13785 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13786
13787Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13788192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13789
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013790IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13791Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13792trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13793IPv6 patterns.
13794
13795HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13796following situations :
13797 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13798 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13799 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13800 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13801 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13802 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13803 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13804 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13805 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13806 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013808
138097.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13810----------------------------------
13811
13812Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13813combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13814
13815 - AND (implicit)
13816 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13817 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013819A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013821 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013823Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13824indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013826For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13827"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13828requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13829is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13830
13831 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013832 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13833 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13834 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013835
13836To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13837and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13838
13839 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13840 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13841 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13842 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13843
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013844 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013845 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13846 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13847 use_backend www if host_www
13848
13849It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13850expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13851be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13852the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13853
13854 The following rule :
13855
13856 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013857 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013858
13859 Can also be written that way :
13860
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013861 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013862
13863It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13864to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13865simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13866sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13867good use is the following :
13868
13869 With named ACLs :
13870
13871 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13872 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13873 monitor fail if site_dead
13874
13875 With anonymous ACLs :
13876
13877 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13878
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013879See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13880keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013881
13882
138837.3. Fetching samples
13884---------------------
13885
13886Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13887against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13888sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13889ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13890of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13891available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13892
13893This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13894Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13895compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13896deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13897
13898The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13899matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13900method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13901indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13902
13903As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13904when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13905mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13906the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13907ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13908
13909Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13910multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13911when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013912incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13913are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013914is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13915all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13916
13917Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13918 - name
13919 - name(arg1)
13920 - name(arg1,arg2)
13921
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013922
139237.3.1. Converters
13924-----------------
13925
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013926Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13927of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13928is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13929was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013930has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013931unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13932
13933These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13934sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13935the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013936support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013937
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013938A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13939support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13940supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13941(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13942bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013944The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013945
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001394651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13947 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13948 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13949 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13950 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13951 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13952
13953 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013954 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13955 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013956 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13957 frontend http-in
13958 bind *:8081
13959 default_backend servers
13960 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13961 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13962
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013963add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013964 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013965 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013966 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13967 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013968 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013969 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13970 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13971 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13972 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013973 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013974 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013975
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013976aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13977 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13978 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13979 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13980 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13981 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13982 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13983
13984 Example:
13985 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13986 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13987
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013988and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013989 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013990 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013991 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13992 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013993 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013994 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13995 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13996 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13997 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013998 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013999 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014000
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014001b64dec
14002 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14003 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14004
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014005base64
14006 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014007 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014008 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14009
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014010bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014011 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014012 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014013 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014014 presence of a flag).
14015
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014016bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14017 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14018 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014019 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014020
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014021concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14022 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14023 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14024 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14025 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14026 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14027 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14028 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14029 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14030 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14031 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014032 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14033 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14034 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14035 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014036
14037 Example:
14038 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14039 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14040 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014041 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014042 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14043
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014044cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014045 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14046 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014047
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014048crc32([<avalanche>])
14049 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14050 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14051 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14052 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14053 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14054 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14055 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14056 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14057 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14058 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014059 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14060
14061crc32c([<avalanche>])
14062 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14063 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14064 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14065 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14066 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14067 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14068 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14069 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014070
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014071cut_crlf
14072 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14073 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14074 updated.
14075
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014076da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014077 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14078 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14079 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14080 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014081 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014082 configuration language.
14083
14084 Example:
14085 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014086 bind *:8881
14087 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014088 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014089
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014090debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14091 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14092 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14093 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14094 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14095 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14096 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14097 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14098 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14099 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14100 printable sample types.
14101
14102 Example:
14103 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014104
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014105div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014106 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14107 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014108 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014109 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14110 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014111 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014112 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14113 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14114 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14115 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014116 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014117 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014118
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014119djb2([<avalanche>])
14120 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14121 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14122 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14123 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14124 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14125 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14126 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014127 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14128 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014129
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014130even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014131 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014132 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14133
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014134field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14135 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14136 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14137 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14138 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14139 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14140 fields.
14141
14142 Example :
14143 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14144 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14145 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14146 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14147 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014148
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014149hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014150 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014151 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014152 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014153 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014154
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014155hex2i
14156 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014157 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014158
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014159htonl
14160 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14161 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14162 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14163 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14164
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014165http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014166 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14167 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014168 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14169 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14170 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14171 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14172 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14173 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14174 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14175 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014176
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014177in_table(<table>)
14178 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14179 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14180 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014181 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014182 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14183
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014184ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14185 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014186 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014187 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14188 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14189 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14190 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14191 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014192
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014193json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014194 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014195 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014196 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014197 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14198 of errors:
14199 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14200 bytes, ...)
14201 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14202 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14203
14204 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14205 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14206 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14207 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14208 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14209 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014210 - "ascii" : never fails;
14211 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14212 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014213 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014214 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014215 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14216 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14217
14218 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014219 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014220
14221 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014222 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014223 capture request header user-agent len 150
14224 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014225
14226 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14227 GET / HTTP/1.0
14228 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14229
14230 Output log:
14231 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14232
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014233language(<value>[,<default>])
14234 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14235 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14236 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14237 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14238 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14239 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14240 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14241 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14242 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014243 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014244 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14245 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014246
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014247 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014248
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014249 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14250 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014251
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014252 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14253 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14254 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14255 use_backend spanish if es
14256 use_backend french if fr
14257 use_backend english if en
14258 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014259
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014260length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014261 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14262 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14263 type. The result is of type integer.
14264
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014265lower
14266 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14267 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14268 type. The result is of type string.
14269
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014270ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14271 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14272 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14273 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14274 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14275 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14276 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14277
14278 Example :
14279
14280 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014281 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014282 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14283
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014284ltrim(<chars>)
14285 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14286 representation of the input sample.
14287
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014288map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14289map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14290map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14291 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14292 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14293 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14294 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14295 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14296 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14297 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14298 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014299
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014300 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14301 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14302 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014303
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014304 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014305 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014306
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014307 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14308 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14309 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14310 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014311 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14312 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014313 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14314 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14315 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14316 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14317 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14318 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14319 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14320 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014321 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14322 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14323 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014324 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14325 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14326 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14327 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14328 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014329
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014330 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14331 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14332 the corresponding match text.
14333
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014334 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14335 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14336 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14337 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14338 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014339
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014340 Example :
14341
14342 # this is a comment and is ignored
14343 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14344 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14345 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14346 | | | `---------- value
14347 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14348 | `---------------------------- key
14349 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14350
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014351mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014352 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14353 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014354 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014355 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014356 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014357 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14358 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14359 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14360 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014361 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014362 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014363
14364mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014365 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014366 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14367 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014368 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014369 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014370 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014371 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14372 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14373 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14374 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014375 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014376 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014377
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014378nbsrv
14379 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14380 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14381 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14382 map lookup.
14383
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014384neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014385 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14386 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14387 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14388 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014389
14390not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014391 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014392 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014393 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014394 absence of a flag).
14395
14396odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014397 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014398 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14399
14400or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014401 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014402 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014403 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14404 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014405 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014406 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14407 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14408 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14409 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014410 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014411 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014412
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014413protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14414 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14415 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14416 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14417 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14418 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14419 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14420 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14421 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14422 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14423 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14424 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14425
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014426regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014427 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14428 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14429 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14430 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14431 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14432 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14433 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14434 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14435 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014436 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14437 of characters with other ones.
14438
14439 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14440 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14441 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14442 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14443 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14444 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014445
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014446 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014447
14448 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14449 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14450 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014451 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014452
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014453 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14454 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14455
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014456 # capture groups and backreferences
14457 # both lines do the same.
14458 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14459 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14460
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014461capture-req(<id>)
14462 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14463 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14464
14465 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014466 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14467 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014468
14469capture-res(<id>)
14470 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14471 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14472
14473 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014474 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14475 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014476
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020014477rtrim(<chars>)
14478 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
14479 of the input sample.
14480
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014481sdbm([<avalanche>])
14482 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14483 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14484 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14485 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14486 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14487 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14488 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014489 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14490 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014491
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014492set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014493 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14494 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14495 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014496 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014497 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14498 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014499 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014500 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14501 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014502 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014503 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014504
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014505sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014506 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014507 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14508
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014509sha2([<bits>])
14510 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14511 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14512
14513 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14514 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14515
14516 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14517 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14518
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014519srv_queue
14520 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14521 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14522 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14523 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14524 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14525
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014526strcmp(<var>)
14527 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14528 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14529 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14530 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14531 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14532 shorter).
14533
14534 Example :
14535
14536 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14537 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14538 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14539
14540
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014541sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014542 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14543 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014544 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014545 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14546 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014547 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014548 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14549 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014550 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014551 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14552 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014553 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014554 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014555
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014556table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14557 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14558 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14559 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14560 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14561 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14562 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14563
14564
14565table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14566 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14567 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14568 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14569 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14570 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14571 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14572
14573table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14574 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14575 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014576 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014577 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14578 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14579
14580table_conn_cur(<table>)
14581 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14582 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14583 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14584 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14585 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14586
14587table_conn_rate(<table>)
14588 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14589 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14590 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14591 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14592 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14593
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014594table_gpt0(<table>)
14595 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14596 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14597 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14598 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14599 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14600
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014601table_gpc0(<table>)
14602 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14603 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14604 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14605 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14606 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14607
14608table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14609 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14610 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14611 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14612 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14613 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14614 sample fetch keyword.
14615
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014616table_gpc1(<table>)
14617 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14618 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14619 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14620 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14621 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14622
14623table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14624 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14625 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14626 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14627 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14628 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14629 sample fetch keyword.
14630
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014631table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14632 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14633 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014634 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014635 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14636 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14637
14638table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14639 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14640 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14641 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14642 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14643 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14644 keyword.
14645
14646table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14647 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14648 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014649 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014650 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14651 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14652
14653table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14654 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14655 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14656 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14657 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14658 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14659 keyword.
14660
14661table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14662 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14663 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014664 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014665 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14666 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14667 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14668 keyword.
14669
14670table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14671 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14672 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014673 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014674 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14675 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14676 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14677 keyword.
14678
14679table_server_id(<table>)
14680 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14681 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14682 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14683 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14684 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14685 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14686
14687table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14688 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14689 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014690 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014691 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14692 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14693 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14694 keyword.
14695
14696table_sess_rate(<table>)
14697 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14698 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14699 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14700 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14701 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14702 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14703 keyword.
14704
14705table_trackers(<table>)
14706 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14707 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14708 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14709 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14710 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14711 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14712 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14713 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14714 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14715 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14716
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014717upper
14718 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14719 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14720 type. The result is of type string.
14721
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014722url_dec([<in_form>])
14723 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14724 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14725 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14726 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14727 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14728 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014729
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014730ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014731 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014732 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14733 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14734 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014735 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14736 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14737 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14738 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014739 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014740 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14741 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014742
14743 Example:
14744 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14745 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14746
14747 message Point {
14748 int32 latitude = 1;
14749 int32 longitude = 2;
14750 }
14751
14752 message PPoint {
14753 Point point = 59;
14754 }
14755
14756 message Rectangle {
14757 // One corner of the rectangle.
14758 PPoint lo = 48;
14759 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14760 PPoint hi = 49;
14761 }
14762
14763 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14764 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14765 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14766
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014767 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14768 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014769 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014770 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14771
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014772 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014773
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014774 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014775
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014776 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014777 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14778 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14779
14780 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14781 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14782 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14783
14784 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14785 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14786 interpret the previous binary sample.
14787
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014788
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014789unset-var(<var name>)
14790 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14791 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14792 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14793 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14794 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14795 response),
14796 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14797 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14798 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14799 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14800
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014801utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14802 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14803 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14804 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14805 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14806 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14807 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14808
14809 Example :
14810
14811 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014812 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014813 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14814
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014815word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14816 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14817 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14818 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014819 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014820 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14821 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14822
14823 Example :
14824 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14825 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14826 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14827 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14828 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014829 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014830
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014831wt6([<avalanche>])
14832 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14833 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14834 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14835 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14836 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14837 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14838 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014839 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14840 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014841
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014842xor(<value>)
14843 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014844 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014845 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014846 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014847 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014848 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14849 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014850 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014851 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14852 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014853 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014854 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014855
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014856xxh32([<seed>])
14857 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14858 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14859 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14860 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14861 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14862 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14863 as cryptographically secure.
14864
14865xxh64([<seed>])
14866 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14867 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14868 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14869 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14870 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14871 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14872 as cryptographically secure.
14873
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014874
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200148757.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014876--------------------------------------------
14877
14878A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14879not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14880"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14881The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14882
14883always_false : boolean
14884 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14885 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14886
14887always_true : boolean
14888 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14889 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14890
14891avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014892 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014893 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14894 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14895 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14896 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14897 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14898 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14899 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14900 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14901 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14902 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14903 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14904 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14905 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014907be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014908 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14909 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14910 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14911 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014912 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14913
14914be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14915 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14916 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14917 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14918 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14919 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014920 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14921 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014922
14923 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14924 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14925 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014927be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14928 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14929 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14930 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014931 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014932 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14933 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014934
14935 Example :
14936 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14937 backend dynamic
14938 mode http
14939 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14940 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014941
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014942bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014943 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14944 of the string.
14945
14946bool(<bool>) : bool
14947 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14948 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14951 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014952 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014953 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14954 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014955
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014956 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014957 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014958 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14959
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014960 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14961 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014962
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014963 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014964 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014965 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014966 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014967 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014968 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014969 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014970
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014971 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14972 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014973 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014974 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014975
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014976cpu_calls : integer
14977 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14978 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14979 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14980 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14981 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14982 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14983
14984cpu_ns_avg : integer
14985 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14986 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14987 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14988 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14989 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14990 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14991 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14992 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14993 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14994 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14995 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14996
14997cpu_ns_tot : integer
14998 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14999 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15000 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15001 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15002 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15003 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15004 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15005 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15006 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15007 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15008 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15009 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15010 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15011
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015012date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015013 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015014
15015 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15016 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15017 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015018 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15019
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015020 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15021 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15022 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15023 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15024 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15025
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015026 Example :
15027
15028 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15029 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015030
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015031 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15032 # millisecond granularity
15033 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15034
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015035date_us : integer
15036 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15037 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15038 from the same timeval structure.
15039
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015040distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15041 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15042 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15043 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15044 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15045 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15046 list of supported tokens.
15047
15048distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15049 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15050 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15051 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15052 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15053 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15054 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15055 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15056 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15057 supported tokens.
15058
15059 Example :
15060 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15061 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15062 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15063 # send large files to the big farm
15064 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15065
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015066env(<name>) : string
15067 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15068 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15069 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15070 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15071 certain way.
15072
15073 Examples :
15074 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15075 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15076
15077 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15078 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015080fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15081 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015082 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15083 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015084 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15085 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015086 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015087 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15088 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015089
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015090fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15091 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15092 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15093 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015095fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15096 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15097 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15098 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15099 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15100 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15101 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15102 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15103 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015104
15105 Example :
15106 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15107 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15108 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15109 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15110 frontend mail
15111 bind :25
15112 mode tcp
15113 maxconn 100
15114 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15115 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15116 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15117 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015118
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015119hostname : string
15120 Returns the system hostname.
15121
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015122int(<integer>) : signed integer
15123 Returns a signed integer.
15124
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015125ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15126 Returns an ipv4.
15127
15128ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15129 Returns an ipv6.
15130
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015131lat_ns_avg : integer
15132 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15133 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15134 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15135 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15136 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15137 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15138 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15139 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15140 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15141 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15142 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15143 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15144 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15145 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15146
15147lat_ns_tot : integer
15148 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15149 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15150 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15151 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15152 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15153 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15154 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15155 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15156 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15157 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15158 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15159 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15160 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15161 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15162 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15163 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15164 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15165 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15166 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15167
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015168meth(<method>) : method
15169 Returns a method.
15170
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015171nbproc : integer
15172 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15173 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15174 and debugging purposes.
15175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015176nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15177 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15178 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15179 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015180 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15181 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15182 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015183
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015184prio_class : integer
15185 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15186 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15187 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15188
15189prio_offset : integer
15190 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15191 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15192 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15193 set-priority-offset".
15194
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015195proc : integer
15196 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15197 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15198 debugging purposes.
15199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015200queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015201 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15202 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15203 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015204 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15205 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15206 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15207 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15208 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15209
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015210rand([<range>]) : integer
15211 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15212 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15213 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15214 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15215 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15216
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015217uuid([<version>]) : string
15218 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15219 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15220 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015222srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15223 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15224 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15225 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15226 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15227 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015228 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15229 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15230
15231srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15232 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15233 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15234 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15235 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15236 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15237 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15238 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15239
15240 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15241 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015242
15243srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15244 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15245 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15246 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015247 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015248 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15249 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15250 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15251
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015252srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15253 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15254 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15255 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15256 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15257 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15258 fetch methods.
15259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015260srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15261 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15262 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015263 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015264 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15265 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015266 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015267 overloading servers).
15268
15269 Example :
15270 # Redirect to a separate back
15271 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15272 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15273 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15274
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015275stopping : boolean
15276 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15277 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15278 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15279
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015280str(<string>) : string
15281 Returns a string.
15282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015283table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15284 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15285 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15286
15287table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15288 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15289 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15290 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15291
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015292thread : integer
15293 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15294 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15295 and debugging purposes.
15296
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015297var(<var-name>) : undefined
15298 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015299 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15300 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015301 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015302 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15303 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015304 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015305 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15306 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015307 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015308 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015309
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200153107.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015311----------------------------------
15312
15313The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15314closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15315methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15316sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15317TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015318the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15319counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015320"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15321used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15322can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15323Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15324table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15325tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15326currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015327
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015328bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015329 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15330 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15331 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015333be_id : integer
15334 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15335 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15336
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015337be_name : string
15338 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15339 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015341dst : ip
15342 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15343 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15344 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15345 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015346 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15347 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15348 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15349 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15350 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15351 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015352
15353dst_conn : integer
15354 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15355 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15356 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15357 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15358 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15359 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15360 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15361 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015362
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015363dst_is_local : boolean
15364 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15365 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15366 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15367 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015368 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015369 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15370 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15371 it only once per connection.
15372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015373dst_port : integer
15374 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15375 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15376 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15377 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15378 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15379 an HTTP header.
15380
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015381fc_http_major : integer
15382 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15383 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15384 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15385
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015386fc_pp_authority : string
15387 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15388 if any.
15389
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010015390fc_pp_unique_id : string
15391 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15392 if any.
15393
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015394fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15395 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15396 header.
15397
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015398fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15399 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15400 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15401 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15402 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15403 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15404 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15405
15406fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15407 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15408 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15409 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15410 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15411 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15412 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15413
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015414fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015415 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15416 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15417 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15418 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15419
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015420fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015421 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15422 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15423 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15424 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15425
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015426fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015427 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15428 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15429 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15430 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15431
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015432fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015433 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15434 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15435 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15436 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15437
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015438fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015439 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15440 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15441 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15442 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15443
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015444fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015445 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15446 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15447 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15448 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15449
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015450fe_defbe : string
15451 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15452 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015454fe_id : integer
15455 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015456 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15458
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015459fe_name : string
15460 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15461 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15462 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15463
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015464sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015465sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15466sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15467sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015468 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15469 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15470 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15471
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015472sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015473sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15474sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15475sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015476 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15477 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15478 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15479
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015480sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015481sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15482sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15483sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015484 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15485 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015486 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15487 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15488 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015489
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015490 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015491 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15492 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015493 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15494 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15495 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015496 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15497 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15498
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015499sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15500sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15501sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15502sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15503 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15504 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15505 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15506 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15507 when a first ACL was verified.
15508
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015509sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015510sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15511sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15512sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015513 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015514 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15515
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015516sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015517sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15518sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15519sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015520 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15521 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15522 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15523
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015524sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015525sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15526sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15527sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015528 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15529 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15530 See also src_conn_rate.
15531
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015532sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015533sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15534sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15535sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015536 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015537 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015538
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015539sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15540sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15541sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15542sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15543 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15544 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15545
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015546sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15547sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15548sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15549sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15550 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15551 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15552
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015553sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015554sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15555sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15556sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015557 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15558 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15559 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015560 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15561 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15562 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015563
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015564sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15565sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15566sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15567sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15568 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15569 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15570 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15571 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15572 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15573 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15574
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015575sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015576sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15577sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15578sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015579 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015580 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15581 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15582
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015583sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015584sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15585sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15586sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015587 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15588 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15589 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15590 src_http_err_rate.
15591
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015592sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015593sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15594sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15595sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015596 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015597 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15598 src_http_req_cnt.
15599
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015600sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015601sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15602sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15603sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015604 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15605 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15606 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15607 src_http_req_rate.
15608
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015609sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015610sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15611sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15612sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015613 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015614 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15615 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15616 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15617 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015618
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015619 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015620 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15621 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015622 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15623
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015624sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15625sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15626sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15627sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15628 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15629 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15630 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15631 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15632 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15633
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015634sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015635sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15636sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15637sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015638 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15639 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15640 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015641
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015642sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015643sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15644sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15645sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015646 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15647 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15648 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015649
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015650sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015651sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15652sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15653sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015654 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015655 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15656 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15657 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015658 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015659 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15660
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015661sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015662sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15663sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15664sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015665 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15666 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15667 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15668 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15669 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015670 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015671
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015672sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015673sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15674sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15675sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015676 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15677 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15678 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15679
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015680sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015681sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15682sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15683sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015684 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15685 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015686 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015687 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15688 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015689 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15690 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15691 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693so_id : integer
15694 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15695 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15696 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015697
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015698so_name : string
15699 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15700 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15701 strings instead of integers.
15702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015703src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015704 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15706 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15707 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015708 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15709 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15710 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015711 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15712 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15713 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15714 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15715 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15716 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15717 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015718
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015719 Example:
15720 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15721 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015723src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15724 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15725 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15726 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015727 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15730 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15731 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015732 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015733 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015735src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15736 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15737 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15738 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15739 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15740 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15741 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015742
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015743 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015744 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15745 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15746 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15747 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015748 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015749 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15750 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15751
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015752src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15753 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15754 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15755 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15756 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15757 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15758 was verified.
15759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015760src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015761 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015763 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015764 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015766src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015767 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015768 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15769 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015770 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015772src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15773 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15774 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15775 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015776 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015778src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015779 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015780 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015781 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015782 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015783
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015784src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15785 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15786 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15787 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15788 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15789
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015790src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15791 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15792 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15793 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15794 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015796src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015797 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015798 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015799 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15800 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015801 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15802 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15803 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015804
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015805src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15806 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15807 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15808 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15809 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15810 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15811 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15812 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015814src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015815 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015816 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015817 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015818 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015819 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015821src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15822 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15823 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15824 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15825 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015826 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015828src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015829 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015830 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15831 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015832 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015834src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15835 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15836 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15837 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015838 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015839 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015841src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15842 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15843 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15844 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015845 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015846 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15847 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015848
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015849 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015850 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015851 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015852 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015853
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015854src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15855 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15856 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15857 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15858 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15859 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15860 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15861
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015862src_is_local : boolean
15863 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15864 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15865 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15866 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015867 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015868 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15869 once per connection.
15870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015872 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15873 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15874 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15875 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15876 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015878src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015879 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15880 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15881 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15882 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15883 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015885src_port : integer
15886 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15887 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15888 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15889 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015891src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015892 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015893 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15894 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15895 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015896 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15899 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15900 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15901 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15902 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015903 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15906 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15907 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15908 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15909 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15910 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15911 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15912 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15913 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015914
15915 Example :
15916 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15917 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15918 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15919 listen ssh
15920 bind :22
15921 mode tcp
15922 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015923 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015924 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015925 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015927srv_id : integer
15928 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15929 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15930 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015931
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015932srv_name : string
15933 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15934 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15935 debugging.
15936
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200159377.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15941closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15942when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15943usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015944future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015945
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001594651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15947 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15948 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15949 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15950 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15951 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15952
15953 Example :
15954 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15955 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15956 # the request.
15957 frontend http-in
15958 bind *:8081
15959 default_backend servers
15960 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15961 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15962
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015963ssl_bc : boolean
15964 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15965 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15966 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15967
15968ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15969 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15970 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15971
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015972ssl_bc_alpn : string
15973 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15974 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015975 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015976 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15977 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15978 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15979 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15980 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15981 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15982
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015983ssl_bc_cipher : string
15984 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15985 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15986
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015987ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15988 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15989 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15990 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15991
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015992ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15993 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15994 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15995 session or a TLS ticket.
15996
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015997ssl_bc_npn : string
15998 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15999 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016000 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016001 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16002 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16003 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16004 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
16005 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
16006
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016007ssl_bc_protocol : string
16008 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
16009 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16010
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016011ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016012 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016013 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16014 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016015
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016016ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16017 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16018 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16019 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16020
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016021ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16022 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16023 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
16024 if session was reused or not.
16025
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016026ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16027 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16028 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16029 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16030 BoringSSL.
16031
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016032ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16033 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
16034 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016036ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16037 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16038 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16039 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16040 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16041 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016043ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16044 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16045 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16046 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16047 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016048
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016049ssl_c_der : binary
16050 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16051 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16052 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054ssl_c_err : integer
16055 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16056 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16057 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16058 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16059 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016060
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016061ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016062 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16063 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16064 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16065 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16066 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16067 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16068 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16069 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016070 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16071 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16072 LDAP v3.
16073 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16074 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016076ssl_c_key_alg : string
16077 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16078 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16079 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016081ssl_c_notafter : string
16082 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16083 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16084 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016086ssl_c_notbefore : string
16087 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16088 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16089 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016090
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016091ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016092 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16093 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16094 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16095 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16096 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16097 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16098 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16099 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016100 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16101 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16102 LDAP v3.
16103 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16104 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016106ssl_c_serial : binary
16107 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16108 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16109 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016111ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16112 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16113 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16114 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016115 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16116 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16117
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016118 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016119 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016121ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16122 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16123 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16124 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016126ssl_c_used : boolean
16127 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16128 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016130ssl_c_verify : integer
16131 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16132 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16133 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16134 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016136ssl_c_version : integer
16137 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16138 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016139
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016140ssl_f_der : binary
16141 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16142 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16143 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16144
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016145ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016146 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16147 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16148 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16149 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016150 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016151 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16152 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16153 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016154 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16155 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16156 LDAP v3.
16157 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16158 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016160ssl_f_key_alg : string
16161 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16162 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16163 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016165ssl_f_notafter : string
16166 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16167 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16168 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016170ssl_f_notbefore : string
16171 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16172 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16173 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016174
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016175ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016176 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16177 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16178 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16179 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16180 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16181 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16182 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16183 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016184 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16185 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16186 LDAP v3.
16187 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16188 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016190ssl_f_serial : binary
16191 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16192 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16193 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016194
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016195ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16196 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16197 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16198 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016200ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16201 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16202 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16203 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016205ssl_f_version : integer
16206 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16207 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16208
16209ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016210 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16211 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16212 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016214 Example :
16215 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16216 listen http-https
16217 bind :80
16218 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16219 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16220
16221ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16222 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16223 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16224
16225ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016226 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016227 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16228 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16229 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16230 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16231 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16232 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16233 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16234 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016236ssl_fc_cipher : string
16237 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16238 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016239
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016240ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16241 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16242 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016243 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016244
16245ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16246 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16247 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016248 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016249
16250ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16251 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16252 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16253 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016254 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016255 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016256
16257ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16258 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16259 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016260 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016261
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016262ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16263 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16264 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16265 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016267ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016268 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16269 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016270 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16271 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16272 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16273 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016274
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016275ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16276 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16277 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16278 wait until the handshake happened.
16279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016280ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16281 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016282 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16283 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016284 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016285 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016286
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016287ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016288 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016289 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16290 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016292ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016293 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016294 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16295 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16296 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16297 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16298 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16299 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16300 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016302ssl_fc_protocol : string
16303 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16304 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016305
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016306ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016307 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016308 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16309 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016310
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016311ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16312 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16313 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16314 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016316ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16317 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16318 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16319 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16320 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016321
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016322ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16323 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16324 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16325 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16326 BoringSSL.
16327
16328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016329ssl_fc_sni : string
16330 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16331 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16332 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16333 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16334 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16335
16336 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16337 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16338 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016339 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016340 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016342 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016343 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16344 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016346ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16347 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16348 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016349
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016350
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163517.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016352------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016354Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16355sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16356only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16357For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16358be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16359can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16360sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16361for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16362content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016364payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016365 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016366 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16367 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016369payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16370 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016371 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016372 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016373
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016374req.hdrs : string
16375 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16376 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16377 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16378 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16379
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016380req.hdrs_bin : binary
16381 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16382 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16383 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16384 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16385 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16386 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16387
16388 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16389
16390 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16391 str: <int:length><bytes>
16392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016393req.len : integer
16394req_len : integer (deprecated)
16395 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16396 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16397 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16398 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16399 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16400 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16401 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16402 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016404req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16405 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016406 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16407 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16408 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16409 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016411 ACL alternatives :
16412 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016414req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16415 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16416 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16417 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16418 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016420 ACL alternatives :
16421 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016423 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016425req.proto_http : boolean
16426req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16427 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16428 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16429 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16430 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16431 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16432 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16433 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016435 Example:
16436 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16437 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16438 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016439 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016441req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16442rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16443 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16444 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16445 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16446 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16447 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16448 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16449 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016451 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16452 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16453 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16454 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16455 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16456 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016458 ACL derivatives :
16459 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016461 Example :
16462 listen tse-farm
16463 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16464 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16465 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16466 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16467 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16468 persist rdp-cookie
16469 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16470 # This is only useful makes sense if
16471 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16472 stick-table type string size 204800
16473 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16474 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16475 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016477 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16478 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016480req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16481rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16482 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16483 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16484 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16485 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016487 ACL derivatives :
16488 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016489
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016490req.ssl_alpn : string
16491 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16492 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16493 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16494 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16495 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16496 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016497 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016498
16499 Examples :
16500 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16501 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16502 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016503 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016504 default_backend bk_default
16505
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016506req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16507 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16508 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016509 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16510 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16511 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16512 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16513 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016515req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16516req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16517 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16518 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16519 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16520 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16521 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16522 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16523 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016525req.ssl_sni : string
16526req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16527 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16528 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16529 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16530 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16531 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16532 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16533 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16534 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16535 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16536 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16537 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16538 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016540 ACL derivatives :
16541 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016543 Examples :
16544 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16545 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16546 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16547 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16548 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016549
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016550req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16551 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16552 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16553 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16554 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16555 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16556 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16557 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16558 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16559 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016561req.ssl_ver : integer
16562req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16563 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16564 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16565 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16566 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16567 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16568 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16569 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016570 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016571 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016573 ACL derivatives :
16574 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016575
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016576res.len : integer
16577 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16578 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16579 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16580 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16581 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16582 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16583 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16584 content inspection.
16585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016586res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16587 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016588 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16589 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16590 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16591 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016593res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16594 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16595 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16596 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16597 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016599 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016600
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016601res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16602rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16603 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16604 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16605 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16606 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16607 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16608 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16609 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016611wait_end : boolean
16612 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16613 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016614 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016615 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16616 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016617 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016618 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16619 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016621 Examples :
16622 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16623 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16624 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016626 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16627 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16628 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16629 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16630 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16631 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16632 tcp-request content reject
16633
16634
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200166357.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016636--------------------------------------
16637
16638It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16639This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16640data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16641its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16642HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16643content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16644to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16645more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16646response are indexed.
16647
16648base : string
16649 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16650 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16651 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16652 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16653 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16654 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16655 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16656 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16657
16658 ACL derivatives :
16659 base : exact string match
16660 base_beg : prefix match
16661 base_dir : subdir match
16662 base_dom : domain match
16663 base_end : suffix match
16664 base_len : length match
16665 base_reg : regex match
16666 base_sub : substring match
16667
16668base32 : integer
16669 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16670 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16671 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016672 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16673 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16674 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016675
16676base32+src : binary
16677 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16678 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16679 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16680 per-URL counters.
16681
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016682capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16683 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16684 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16685 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16686
16687capture.req.method : string
16688 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16689 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16690 because it's allocated.
16691
16692capture.req.uri : string
16693 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16694 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16695 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16696 allocated.
16697
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016698capture.req.ver : string
16699 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16700 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16701 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16702
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016703capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16704 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16705 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16706 The first entry is an index of 0.
16707 See also: "capture response header"
16708
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016709capture.res.ver : string
16710 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16711 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16712 persistent flag.
16713
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016714req.body : binary
16715 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16716 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16717 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16718 the first chunk is analyzed.
16719
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016720req.body_param([<name>) : string
16721 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16722 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16723 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16724 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16725 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16726 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16727 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16728 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16729 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16730 given.
16731
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016732req.body_len : integer
16733 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16734 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16735 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16736 "option http-buffer-request".
16737
16738req.body_size : integer
16739 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16740 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16741 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16742 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16743 "option http-buffer-request".
16744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016745req.cook([<name>]) : string
16746cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16747 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16748 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16749 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16750 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16751 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16752 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16753 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16754 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16755
16756 ACL derivatives :
16757 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16758 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16759 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16760 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16761 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16762 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16763 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16764 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016766req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16767cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16768 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16769 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016771req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16772cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16773 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16774 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16775 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16776 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016778cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16779 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16780 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16781 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16782 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016783 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016784 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16785 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16786 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16787 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016789hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16790 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16791 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16792 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16793 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016794 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016796req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16797 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16798 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16799 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16800 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16801 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16802 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16803 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16804 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016806req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16807 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16808 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16809 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16810 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016812req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16813 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16814 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16815 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16816 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16817 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16818 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16819 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16820 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016821 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016822 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016823 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016825 ACL derivatives :
16826 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16827 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16828 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16829 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16830 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16831 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16832 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16833 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16834
16835req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16836hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16837 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16838 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16839 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16840 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16841 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16842 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16843 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16844 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16845 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16846
16847req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16848hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16849 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16850 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16851 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16852 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16853 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016854 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016855 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16856 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16857
16858req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16859hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16860 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16861 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16862 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16863 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16864 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16865 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16866 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16867
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016868
16869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016870http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16871 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16872 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16873 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16874 basic auth is supported.
16875
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016876http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16877 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16878 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16879 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16880 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016881 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16882 basic auth is supported.
16883
16884 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016885 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16886 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16887 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16888 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016889
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016890http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016891 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16892 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16893 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016894
16895http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016896 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16897 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16898 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016899
16900http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016901 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16902 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16903 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016905http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016906 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16907 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016908 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16909 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016911method : integer + string
16912 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16913 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16914 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16915 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16916 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16917 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16918 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016920 ACL derivatives :
16921 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016923 Example :
16924 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16925 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16926 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016928path : string
16929 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16930 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16931 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16932 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16933 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016934 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016935 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016937 ACL derivatives :
16938 path : exact string match
16939 path_beg : prefix match
16940 path_dir : subdir match
16941 path_dom : domain match
16942 path_end : suffix match
16943 path_len : length match
16944 path_reg : regex match
16945 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016946
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016947query : string
16948 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16949 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16950 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16951 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016952 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016953 which stops before the question mark.
16954
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016955req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16956 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16957 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16958 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16959 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016961req.ver : string
16962req_ver : string (deprecated)
16963 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16964 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16965 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016967 ACL derivatives :
16968 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016970res.comp : boolean
16971 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16972 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16973 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016975res.comp_algo : string
16976 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16977 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16978 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016980res.cook([<name>]) : string
16981scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16982 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16983 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16984 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016986 ACL derivatives :
16987 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016989res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16990scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16991 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16992 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16993 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016995res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16996scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16997 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16998 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16999 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017001res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17002 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17003 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17004 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17005 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17006 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17007 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17008 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17009 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
17010 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017012res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17013 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17014 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17015 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17016 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
17017 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017019res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17020shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17021 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17022 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17023 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17024 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17025 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17026 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17027 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
17028 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017030 ACL derivatives :
17031 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17032 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17033 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17034 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17035 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17036 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17037 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17038 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17039
17040res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17041shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17042 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17043 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17044 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17045 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
17046 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017048res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17049shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17050 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17051 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17052 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17053 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17054 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
17055 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017056
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017057res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17058 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17059 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17060 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17061 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017063res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17064shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17065 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17066 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17067 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17068 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17069 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
17070 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017072res.ver : string
17073resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17074 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
17075 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017077 ACL derivatives :
17078 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017080set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17081 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17082 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017083 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017084 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017086 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17087 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017089status : integer
17090 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17091 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
17092 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017093
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017094unique-id : string
17095 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17096 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17097 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17098 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17099 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17100 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017102url : string
17103 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17104 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17105 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17106 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17107 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17108 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17109 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017111 ACL derivatives :
17112 url : exact string match
17113 url_beg : prefix match
17114 url_dir : subdir match
17115 url_dom : domain match
17116 url_end : suffix match
17117 url_len : length match
17118 url_reg : regex match
17119 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017121url_ip : ip
17122 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17123 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17124 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17125 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17126 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17127 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17128 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017130url_port : integer
17131 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17132 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17133 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17134 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017135
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017136urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17137url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017138 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
17139 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017140 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
17141 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
17142 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
17143 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017144 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
17145 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017146 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
17147 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017149 ACL derivatives :
17150 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
17151 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
17152 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
17153 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
17154 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
17155 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
17156 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
17157 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017158
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017160 Example :
17161 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
17162 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
17163 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
17164 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017165
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017166urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017167 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
17168 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17169 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017170
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017171url32 : integer
17172 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17173 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17174 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17175 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17176 is an unsigned integer.
17177
17178url32+src : binary
17179 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17180 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17181 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17182
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010017183
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +0200171847.3.7. Fetching health-check samples
17185-------------------------------------
17186
17187This set of sample fetch methods may be called from an health-check execution
17188context. It was introduced in the version 2.2. The following sample fetches are
17189placed in the dedicated scope "check". Other sample fetches may also be called
17190when an health-check is performed if it makes sense and if the sample fetch was
17191adapted to be called in this context.
17192
17193check.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17194 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
17195 in the check input buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is
17196 zero, then the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can
17197 be called from a tcp-check expect rule, or eventually from a set-var rule
17198 after an expect rule and before a send rule (check input buffer is filled on
17199 tcp-check expect rules and reset on tcp-check send rules).
17200
17201
172027.3.8. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017203---------------------------------------
17204
17205This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17206used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17207purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17208There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17209or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17210any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17211for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17212
17213internal.htx.data : integer
17214 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17215 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17216
17217internal.htx.free : integer
17218 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17219 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17220
17221internal.htx.free_data : integer
17222 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17223 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17224
17225internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17226 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17227 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17228 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17229
17230internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17231 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17232 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17233
17234internal.htx.size : integer
17235 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17236 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17237
17238internal.htx.used : integer
17239 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17240 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17241 direction.
17242
17243internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17244 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17245 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17246 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17247 of the special value :
17248 * head : The oldest inserted block
17249 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017250 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017251
17252internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17253 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17254 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17255 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17256 integer or one of the special value :
17257 * head : The oldest inserted block
17258 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017259 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017260
17261internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17262 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17263 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17264 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17265 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17266
17267 * head : The oldest inserted block
17268 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017269 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017270
17271internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17272 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17273 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17274 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17275 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17276
17277 * head : The oldest inserted block
17278 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017279 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017280
17281internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17282 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17283 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17284 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17285 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17286
17287 * head : The oldest inserted block
17288 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017289 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017290
17291internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17292 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17293 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17294 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17295 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17296
17297 * head : The oldest inserted block
17298 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017299 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017300
17301internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17302 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17303 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17304 it returns false.
17305
17306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200173077.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017308---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017310Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17311every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017312order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017314ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17315---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017316FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017317HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017318HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17319HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017320HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17321HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17322HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17323HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17324LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017325METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017326METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017327METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17328METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17329METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17330METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017331METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017332METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017333RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017334REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017335TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017336WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17337---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017338
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173408. Logging
17341----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017342
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017343One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17344provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17345very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17346provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17347state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017348to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017349headers.
17350
17351In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17352about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17353send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17354
17355 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17356 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17357 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17358 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17359 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017360 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017361 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017362
17363The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17364allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17365as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17366while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17367real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17368delay.
17369
17370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173718.1. Log levels
17372---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017373
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017374TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017375source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017376HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17377in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17378track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17379syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17380about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017381
17382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173838.2. Log formats
17384----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017385
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017386HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017387and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17388slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17389options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017390
17391 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17392 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17393 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17394 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17395 extents.
17396
17397 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17398 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17399 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17400 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17401 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17402
17403 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17404 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17405 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17406 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17407 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17408
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017409 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17410 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17411 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17412 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17413
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017414 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17415
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017416Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17417specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17418field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17419servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17420always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17421identifier.
17422
17423Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17424 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17425 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17426 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17427 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17428
17429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174308.2.1. Default log format
17431-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017432
17433This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17434as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17435format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17436
17437 Example :
17438 listen www
17439 mode http
17440 log global
17441 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17442
17443 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17444 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17445 (www/HTTP)
17446
17447 Field Format Extract from the example above
17448 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17449 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17450 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17451 4 'to' to
17452 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17453 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17454
17455Detailed fields description :
17456 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17457 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17458 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17459 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17460 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17461 and processed the connection.
17462 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17463
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017464In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17465"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17466connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17467
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017468It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17469will eventually disappear.
17470
17471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174728.2.2. TCP log format
17473---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017474
17475The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17476is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17477information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17478counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17479emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17480environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17481the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17482sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017483specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17484not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17485fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17486marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017487
17488 Example :
17489 frontend fnt
17490 mode tcp
17491 option tcplog
17492 log global
17493 default_backend bck
17494
17495 backend bck
17496 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17497
17498 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17499 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17500 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17501
17502 Field Format Extract from the example above
17503 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17504 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17505 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17506 4 frontend_name fnt
17507 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17508 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17509 7 bytes_read* 212
17510 8 termination_state --
17511 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17512 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17513
17514Detailed fields description :
17515 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017516 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17517 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17518 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017519 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017520 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017521 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017522
17523 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017524 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17525 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17526 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017527
17528 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17529 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17530 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017531 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17532 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17533 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17534 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017535
17536 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17537 and processed the connection.
17538
17539 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17540 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17541 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17542 applications.
17543
17544 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17545 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17546 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17547 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17548 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17549
17550 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17551 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17552 See "Timers" below for more details.
17553
17554 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17555 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17556 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17557 "Timers" below for more details.
17558
17559 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017560 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017561 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17562 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17563 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17564 details.
17565
17566 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17567 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17568 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17569 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17570 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17571
17572 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17573 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17574 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17575 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17576 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17577 for more details.
17578
17579 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017580 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017581 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17582 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17583 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017584 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017585
17586 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17587 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17588 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17589 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17590 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17591 caused by a denial of service attack.
17592
17593 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17594 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17595 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17596 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17597 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17598 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17599 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17600 denial of service attack.
17601
17602 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17603 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17604 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17605 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17606 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17607 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17608 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17609 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17610 be processed than on other servers.
17611
17612 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17613 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17614 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17615 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17616 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17617 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17618 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17619 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17620 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17621 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17622 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17623 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17624 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17625
17626 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17627 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17628 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17629 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17630 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17631 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017632 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017633 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17634
17635 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17636 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17637 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17638 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17639 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17640 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017641 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017642 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17643 occurs.
17644
17645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176468.2.3. HTTP log format
17647----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017648
17649The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17650is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17651the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17652are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17653emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17654generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17655"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17656which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017657frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17658is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017659
17660Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17661slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17662with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17663
17664 Example :
17665 frontend http-in
17666 mode http
17667 option httplog
17668 log global
17669 default_backend bck
17670
17671 backend static
17672 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17673
17674 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17675 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17676 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017677 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017678
17679 Field Format Extract from the example above
17680 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17681 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017682 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017683 4 frontend_name http-in
17684 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017685 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017686 7 status_code 200
17687 8 bytes_read* 2750
17688 9 captured_request_cookie -
17689 10 captured_response_cookie -
17690 11 termination_state ----
17691 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17692 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17693 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17694 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17695 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017696
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017697Detailed fields description :
17698 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017699 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17700 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17701 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017702 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017703 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017704 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017705
17706 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017707 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17708 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17709 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017710
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017711 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17712 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017713
17714 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17715 and processed the connection.
17716
17717 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17718 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17719 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17720
17721 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17722 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17723 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17724 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17725 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17726 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17727
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017728 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17729 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17730 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017731 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017732 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17733 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017734 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17735 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017736
17737 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17738 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017739 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017740
17741 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17742 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017743 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17744 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017745
17746 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17747 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17748 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17749 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17750 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017751 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17752 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017753
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017754 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17755 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17756 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17757 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17758 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17759 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17760 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017761 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017762
17763 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17764 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17765 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17766
17767 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17768 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017769 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017770 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17771 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17772 overflowing.
17773
17774 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17775 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17776 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17777 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17778 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17779 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17780 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17781 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17782
17783 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17784 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17785 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17786 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17787 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17788 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17789 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17790 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17791
17792 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17793 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17794 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17795 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17796 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17797 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17798 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17799
17800 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017801 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017802 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17803 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17804 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017805 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017806 system.
17807
17808 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17809 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17810 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17811 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17812 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17813 caused by a denial of service attack.
17814
17815 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17816 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17817 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17818 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17819 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17820 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17821 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17822 denial of service attack.
17823
17824 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17825 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17826 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17827 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17828 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17829 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17830 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17831 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17832 processed than on other servers.
17833
17834 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17835 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17836 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17837 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17838 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17839 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17840 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17841 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17842 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17843 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17844 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17845 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17846 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17847
17848 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17849 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17850 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17851 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17852 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17853 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017854 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017855 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17856
17857 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17858 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17859 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17860 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17861 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17862 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017863 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017864 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17865 occurs.
17866
17867 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17868 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17869 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17870 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17871 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17872 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17873 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17874 cookies" below for more details.
17875
17876 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17877 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17878 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17879 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17880 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17881 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17882 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17883 and cookies" below for more details.
17884
17885 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17886 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17887 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17888 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17889 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17890 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17891 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17892 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17893
17894
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200178958.2.4. Custom log format
17896------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017897
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017898The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017899mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017900
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017901HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017902Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17903separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17904prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17905
17906Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17907variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017908("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017909
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017910If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017911as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017912less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17913the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17914
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017915Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017916In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017917in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017918
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017919Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17920'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17921https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17922such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17923
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017924Flags are :
17925 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017926 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017927 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17928 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017929
17930 Example:
17931
17932 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17933 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17934
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017935 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17936
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017937At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17938
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017939 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17940 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017941
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017942the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017943
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017944 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17945 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17946 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017947
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017948and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17949
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017950 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17951 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017952
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017953Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17954
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017955 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017956 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017957 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17958 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17959 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017960 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17961 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17962 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017963 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017964 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17965 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017966 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017967 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17968 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017969 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017970 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017971 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017972 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017973 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017974 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017975 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017976 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17977 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17978 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17979 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17980 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017981 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017982 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17983 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017984 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017985 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17986 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017987 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17988 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17989 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017990 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017991 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17992 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017993 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017994 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17995 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17996 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017997 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017998 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017999 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18000 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18001 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18002 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018003 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018004 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018005 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018006 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018007 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018008 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018009 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18010 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18011 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018012 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018013 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18014 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018015 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018016 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18017 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018018 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018019 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018020 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018021 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018022
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018023 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018024
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018025
180268.2.5. Error log format
18027-----------------------
18028
18029When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18030protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18031By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18032"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018033will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018034logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18035
18036The format looks like this :
18037
18038 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18039 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18040 Connection error during SSL handshake
18041
18042 Field Format Extract from the example above
18043 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18044 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18045 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18046 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18047 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18048
18049These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18050failures.
18051
18052
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180538.3. Advanced logging options
18054-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018055
18056Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18057just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18058options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18059for more information about their usage.
18060
18061
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180628.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18063------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018064
18065It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18066haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18067commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18068monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18069ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18070
18071 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18072 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18073 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18074 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18075
18076 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18077 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18078 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018079 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018080 such as other load-balancers.
18081
18082 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18083 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18084 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18085
18086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180878.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18088----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018089
18090The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18091what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18092or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018093"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018094just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18095log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18096after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18097is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18098with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18099with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18100
18101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18103------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018104
18105Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18106for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18107"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18108retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18109raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18110a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18111file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18112you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18113"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18114
18115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181168.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18117--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018118
18119Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18120multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18121them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18122"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18123logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18124error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18125and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18126too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18127useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18128alternative.
18129
18130
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181318.4. Timing events
18132------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018133
18134Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18135reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18136the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18137frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018138mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18139addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18140
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018141Timings events in HTTP mode:
18142
18143 first request 2nd request
18144 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18145 t tr t tr ...
18146 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18147 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18148 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18149 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
18150 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18151
18152Timings events in TCP mode:
18153
18154 TCP session
18155 |<----------------->|
18156 t t
18157 ---|----|----|----|----|---
18158 | Th Tw Tc Td |
18159 |<------ Tt ------->|
18160
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018161 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018162 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018163 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
18164 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
18165 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018166 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018167 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
18168 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
18169 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
18170 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018171
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018172 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
18173 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
18174 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018175 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
18176 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
18177 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
18178 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
18179 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
18180 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018181
18182 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
18183 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
18184 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
18185 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
18186 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
18187 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
18188 request typed by hand during a test.
18189
18190 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18191 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018192 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018193 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18194 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18195 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18196 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018197
18198 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18199 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18200 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18201 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18202 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18203
18204 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18205 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18206 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18207 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18208 connection never established.
18209
18210 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18211 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18212 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18213 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18214 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18215 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18216 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18217 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18218 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18219 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18220 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18221
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018222 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18223 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18224 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18225 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18226 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18227 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18228
18229 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18230
18231 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18232 "Ta" can never be negative.
18233
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018234 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18235 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018236 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18237 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018238 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018239
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018240 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018241
18242 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018243 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18244 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018245
18246These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18247protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18248that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018249due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18250"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18251that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018252
18253Most common cases :
18254
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018255 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18256 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18257 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18258 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18259 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18260 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18261 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18262 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18263 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18264 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18265 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018266 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018267
18268 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18269 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18270 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18271 of ms on remote networks.
18272
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018273 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18274 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18275 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018276
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018277 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18278 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18279 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18280 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18281 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18282 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18283 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18284 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18285 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018286
18287Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18288
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018289 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018290 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018291 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018292
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018293 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018294 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18295 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18296
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018297 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018298 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18299 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18300 flags.
18301
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018302 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18303 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018304 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18305 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18306 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18307 the client connection was maintained open.
18308
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018309 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018310 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018311 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018312 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18313
18314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183158.5. Session state at disconnection
18316-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018317
18318TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18319"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
183202-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18321each of which has a special meaning :
18322
18323 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18324 session to terminate :
18325
18326 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18327
18328 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18329 server explicitly refused it.
18330
18331 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18332 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18333 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18334 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018335 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018336
18337 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18338 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018339
18340 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18341 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18342 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18343 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18344 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18345
18346 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18347 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18348 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18349 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18350 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18351
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018352 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18353 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18354
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018355 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18356 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18357 backup connections when going up.
18358
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018359 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18360
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018361 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18362 send or receive data.
18363
18364 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18365 send or receive data.
18366
18367 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18368 with nothing left in the buffers.
18369
18370 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18371
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018372 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018373 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18374
18375 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18376 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18377 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18378 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18379 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18380
18381 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18382 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18383
18384 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18385 server (HTTP only).
18386
18387 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18388
18389 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18390 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18391 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18392
18393 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18394 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18395 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18396
18397 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18398
18399 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18400 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18401
18402 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18403 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18404 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18405
18406 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18407 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018408 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18409 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018410
18411 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18412 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18413 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18414 another server.
18415
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018416 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018417 server.
18418
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018419 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18420 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18421 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18422 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18423
18424 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18425 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18426 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18427 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18428
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018429 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18430 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18431 "use-server" rule).
18432
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018433 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18434
18435 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18436 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18437
18438 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18439
18440 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18441 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18442 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18443
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018444 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18445 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018446 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018447 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18448 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18449
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018450 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18451
18452 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18453 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18454
18455 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18456
18457 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18458
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018459The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18460was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018461helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18462starvation, attacks, etc...
18463
18464The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18465alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18466easier finding and understanding.
18467
18468 Flags Reason
18469
18470 -- Normal termination.
18471
18472 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18473 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18474 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18475 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18476
18477 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18478 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18479 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18480 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18481 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18482 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018483
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018484 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18485 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018486 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018487
18488 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18489 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18490 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18491
18492 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18493 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18494 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18495 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18496 the server takes too long to respond.
18497
18498 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18499 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18500 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18501 long a time to respond.
18502
18503 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18504 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18505 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18506 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018507 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18508 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018509
18510 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18511 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18512 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18513 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18514 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018515 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018516 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18517 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18518 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18519 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18520 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18521 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18522 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18523 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018524 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018525 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18526 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18527 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018528
18529 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18530 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018531 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18532 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18533 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18534 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018535
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018536 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18537 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18538
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018539 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018540 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18541 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018542 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018543 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18544 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18545
18546 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18547 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18548 503 or 504 here.
18549
18550 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18551 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18552 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18553 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18554 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18555
18556 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18557 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018558 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018559 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18560 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18561
18562 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18563 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18564 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18565 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18566 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18567 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18568 between haproxy and the server.
18569
18570 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18571 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18572 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18573 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18574 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18575 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18576 solution is to fix the application.
18577
18578 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18579 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18580 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18581 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18582 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18583 external attacks.
18584
18585 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18586 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018587 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018588 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18589 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18590
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018591 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18592 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18593 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018594 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018595 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018596
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018597 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18598 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18599 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18600 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018601 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18602 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18603 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18604 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18605 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018606
18607 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18608 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18609 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18610 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18611
18612 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18613 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18614 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18615 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18616
18617 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18618 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18619 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18620 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18621
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018622The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18623persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18624important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18625re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18626
18627 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18628
18629 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18630 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18631 set on a GET request.
18632
18633 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18634 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018635 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018636 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18637
18638 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18639 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18640 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18641
18642 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18643 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18644 already got a cookie.
18645
18646 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18647 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18648 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18649 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18650 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18651
18652 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18653 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18654 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18655
18656 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18657 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18658 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18659
18660 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18661 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18662
18663 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18664 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18665 then advertised in the response.
18666
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186688.6. Non-printable characters
18669-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018670
18671In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18672consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18673converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18674prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18675being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18676escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18677is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18678'}' when logging headers.
18679
18680Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18681issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18682containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18683
18684Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18685the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18686performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18687
18688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186898.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18690---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018691
18692Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18693achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018694section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018695cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18696the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18697the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018698locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018699not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18700user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18701a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18702wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18703
18704 Examples :
18705 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18706 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18707
18708 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18709 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18710
18711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18713---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018714
18715Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18716proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18717the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18718server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18719
18720Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18721response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018722section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018723
18724It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018725time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18726appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018727are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18728and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18729follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18730request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18731in the logs.
18732
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018733As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18734frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18735an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18736
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018737 Example :
18738 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18739 listen proxy-out
18740 mode http
18741 option httplog
18742 option logasap
18743 log global
18744 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18745
18746 # log the name of the virtual server
18747 capture request header Host len 20
18748
18749 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18750 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18751
18752 # log the beginning of the referrer
18753 capture request header Referer len 20
18754
18755 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18756 capture response header Server len 20
18757
18758 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18759 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18760
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018761 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018762 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18763
18764 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18765 capture response header Via len 20
18766
18767 # log the URL location during a redirection
18768 capture response header Location len 20
18769
18770 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18771 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18772 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18773 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18774 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18775
18776 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18777 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18778 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18779 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018780 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018781
18782 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18783 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18784 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18785 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18786 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018787 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018788
18789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187908.9. Examples of logs
18791---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018792
18793These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18794them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18795reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18796
18797 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18798 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18799 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18800
18801 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18802 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18803
18804 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18805 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18806 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18807
18808 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18809 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18810
18811 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18812 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18813 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18814
18815 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018816 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018817 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18818 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18819
18820 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18821 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18822 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18823
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018824 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18825 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18826 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18827 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18828 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18829 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018830
18831 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018832 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018833
18834 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18835 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18836 Nothing was sent to any server.
18837
18838 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18839 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18840
18841 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18842 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018843 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018844 send a 408 return code to the client.
18845
18846 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18847 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18848
18849 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18850 5 seconds ("c----").
18851
18852 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18853 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018854 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018855
18856 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018857 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018858 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18859 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18860 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18861 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18862 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018863
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018864
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200188659. Supported filters
18866--------------------
18867
18868Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18869accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18870unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18871
18872See also : "filter"
18873
188749.1. Trace
18875----------
18876
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018877filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018878
18879 Arguments:
18880 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18881 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18882
18883 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18884 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18885 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18886 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18887
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018888 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018889 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18890 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18891 amount of the parsed data.
18892
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018893 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018894
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018895This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18896callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18897information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18898filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18899
18900Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18901tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18902a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18903
18904
189059.2. HTTP compression
18906---------------------
18907
18908filter compression
18909
18910The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18911keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018912when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18913fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18914done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18915explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18916filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18917listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18918order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018919
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018920See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18921 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018922
18923
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200189249.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18925--------------------------------------------
18926
18927filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18928
18929 Arguments :
18930
18931 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18932 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18933 parsed.
18934
18935 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18936 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18937 part must be placed in its own scope.
18938
18939The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18940external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018941streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018942exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18943also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18944
18945SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18946the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18947
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018948For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018949"doc/SPOE.txt".
18950
18951Important note:
18952 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18953 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18954
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100189559.4. Cache
18956----------
18957
18958filter cache <name>
18959
18960 Arguments :
18961
18962 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18963
18964The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18965"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018966cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018967other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18968case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18969is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18970filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018971listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18972order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018973
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018974See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18975 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18976
18977
189789.5. Fcgi-app
18979-------------
18980
18981filter fcg-app <name>
18982
18983 Arguments :
18984
18985 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18986
18987The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18988request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18989reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18990used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18991implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18992used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18993fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18994used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18995order.
18996
18997See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18998 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18999
19000
1900110. FastCGI applications
19002-------------------------
19003
19004HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19005feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19006the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19007FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19008servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19009FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19010backend.
19011
19012HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19013application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19014connection.
19015
1901610.1. Setup
19017-----------
19018
1901910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19020--------------------------
19021
19022fcgi-app <name>
19023 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19024 document root must be defined.
19025
19026acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19027 Declare or complete an access list.
19028
19029 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19030 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19031 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19032 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19033 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19034
19035docroot <path>
19036 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19037 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19038 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19039
19040index <script-name>
19041 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19042 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19043 is an optional setting.
19044
19045 Example :
19046 index index.php
19047
19048log-stderr global
19049log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19050 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19051 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19052
19053 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19054 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19055
19056pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19057 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19058 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19059 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19060
19061 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19062 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19063 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19064 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19065
19066 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19067 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19068
19069path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019070 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019071 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19072 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19073 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19074 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19075 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19076 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19077 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019078
19079 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019080 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019081 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19082 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19083 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19084 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019085
19086 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019087 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19088 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019089
19090option get-values
19091no option get-values
19092 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19093
19094 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19095 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19096
19097 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19098 application will accept.
19099
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019100 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19101 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019102
19103 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
19104 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
19105 option is disabled.
19106
19107 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19108 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19109 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19110 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19111 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19112 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19113
19114option keep-conn
19115no option keep-conn
19116 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19117 sending a response.
19118
19119 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19120 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19121
19122option max-reqs <reqs>
19123 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19124 accept.
19125
19126 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19127 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19128 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19129 to 1.
19130
19131option mpxs-conns
19132no option mpxs-conns
19133 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19134
19135 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19136 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19137
19138set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19139 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19140 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19141 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19142 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19143
19144 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19145 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19146 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19147
19148 Example :
19149 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
19150 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
19151
19152 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
19153
19154
1915510.1.2. Proxy section
19156---------------------
19157
19158use-fcgi-app <name>
19159 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
19160
19161 Arguments :
19162 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
19163
19164 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
19165 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
19166 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
19167 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
19168 application may be defined at a time per backend.
19169
19170 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
19171 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
19172 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
19173 application are evaluated.
19174
19175
1917610.1.3. Example
19177---------------
19178
19179 frontend front-http
19180 mode http
19181 bind *:80
19182 bind *:
19183
19184 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
19185 default_backend back-static
19186
19187 backend back-static
19188 mode http
19189 server www A.B.C.D:80
19190
19191 backend back-dynamic
19192 mode http
19193 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19194 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19195
19196 fcgi-app php-fpm
19197 log-stderr global
19198 option keep-conn
19199
19200 docroot /var/www/my-app
19201 index index.php
19202 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19203
19204
1920510.2. Default parameters
19206------------------------
19207
19208A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19209the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019210script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019211applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19212
19213 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19214 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19215 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19216 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19217 | | |
19218 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19219 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19220 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19221 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19222 | | application. |
19223 | | |
19224 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19225 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19226 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19227 | | |
19228 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19229 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19230 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19231 | | the application's configuration. |
19232 | | |
19233 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19234 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19235 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19236 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19237 | | |
19238 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19239 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19240 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19241 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19242 | | be defined. |
19243 | | |
19244 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19245 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19246 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19247 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19248 | | is not set too. |
19249 | | |
19250 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19251 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19252 | | set. |
19253 | | |
19254 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19255 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19256 | | the request. |
19257 | | |
19258 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19259 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19260 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19261 | | |
19262 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19263 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19264 | | script to process the request. |
19265 | | |
19266 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19267 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19268 | | |
19269 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19270 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19271 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19272 | | |
19273 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19274 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19275 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19276 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19277 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19278 | | |
19279 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19280 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19281 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19282 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19283 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19284 | | side. |
19285 | | |
19286 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19287 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19288 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19289 | | connected to. |
19290 | | |
19291 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19292 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19293 | | |
19294 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19295 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19296 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19297 | | |
19298 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19299
19300
1930110.3. Limitations
19302------------------
19303
19304The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19305way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19306during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19307establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19308application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19309or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19310message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19311these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19312and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19313
19314Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19315request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19316requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19317
19318About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19319into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19320fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19321"http-request" ones.
19322
19323Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19324FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19325processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19326must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19327here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019328
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019329/*
19330 * Local variables:
19331 * fill-column: 79
19332 * End:
19333 */